iam

package module
v1.0.0 Latest Latest
Warning

This package is not in the latest version of its module.

Go to latest
Published: Jan 19, 2021 License: Apache-2.0 Imports: 32 Imported by: 586

Documentation

Overview

Package iam provides the API client, operations, and parameter types for AWS Identity and Access Management.

AWS Identity and Access Management AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) is a web service for securely controlling access to AWS services. With IAM, you can centrally manage users, security credentials such as access keys, and permissions that control which AWS resources users and applications can access. For more information about IAM, see AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) (http://aws.amazon.com/iam/) and the AWS Identity and Access Management User Guide (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/).

Index

Constants

View Source
const ServiceAPIVersion = "2010-05-08"
View Source
const ServiceID = "IAM"

Variables

This section is empty.

Functions

func NewDefaultEndpointResolver

func NewDefaultEndpointResolver() *internalendpoints.Resolver

NewDefaultEndpointResolver constructs a new service endpoint resolver

func WithAPIOptions added in v1.0.0

func WithAPIOptions(optFns ...func(*middleware.Stack) error) func(*Options)

WithAPIOptions returns a functional option for setting the Client's APIOptions option.

Types

type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput

type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct {

	// The client ID (also known as audience) to add to the IAM OpenID Connect provider
	// resource.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ClientID *string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider
	// resource to add the client ID to. You can get a list of OIDC provider ARNs by
	// using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string
}

type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput

type AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput

type AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the instance profile to update. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfileName *string

	// The name of the role to add. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput

type AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type AddUserToGroupInput

type AddUserToGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the group to update. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The name of the user to add. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type AddUserToGroupOutput

type AddUserToGroupOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type AttachGroupPolicyInput

type AttachGroupPolicyInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the group to attach the policy to. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string
}

type AttachGroupPolicyOutput

type AttachGroupPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type AttachRolePolicyInput

type AttachRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the role to attach the policy to. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type AttachRolePolicyOutput

type AttachRolePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type AttachUserPolicyInput

type AttachUserPolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to attach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user to attach the policy to. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type AttachUserPolicyOutput

type AttachUserPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ChangePasswordInput

type ChangePasswordInput struct {

	// The new password. The new password must conform to the AWS account's password
	// policy, if one exists. The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) that
	// is used to validate this parameter is a string of characters. That string can
	// include almost any printable ASCII character from the space (\u0020) through the
	// end of the ASCII character range (\u00FF). You can also include the tab
	// (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D) characters. Any of
	// these characters are valid in a password. However, many tools, such as the AWS
	// Management Console, might restrict the ability to type certain characters
	// because they have special meaning within that tool.
	//
	// This member is required.
	NewPassword *string

	// The IAM user's current password.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OldPassword *string
}

type ChangePasswordOutput

type ChangePasswordOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type Client

type Client struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Client provides the API client to make operations call for AWS Identity and Access Management.

func New

func New(options Options, optFns ...func(*Options)) *Client

New returns an initialized Client based on the functional options. Provide additional functional options to further configure the behavior of the client, such as changing the client's endpoint or adding custom middleware behavior.

func NewFromConfig

func NewFromConfig(cfg aws.Config, optFns ...func(*Options)) *Client

NewFromConfig returns a new client from the provided config.

func (*Client) AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider

func (c *Client) AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProvider(ctx context.Context, params *AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AddClientIDToOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error)

Adds a new client ID (also known as audience) to the list of client IDs already registered for the specified IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource. This operation is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you add an existing client ID to the provider.

func (*Client) AddRoleToInstanceProfile

func (c *Client) AddRoleToInstanceProfile(ctx context.Context, params *AddRoleToInstanceProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AddRoleToInstanceProfileOutput, error)

Adds the specified IAM role to the specified instance profile. An instance profile can contain only one role. (The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.) You can remove the existing role and then add a different role to an instance profile. You must then wait for the change to appear across all of AWS because of eventual consistency (https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Eventual_consistency). To force the change, you must disassociate the instance profile (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/APIReference/API_DisassociateIamInstanceProfile.html) and then associate the instance profile (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/APIReference/API_AssociateIamInstanceProfile.html), or you can stop your instance and then restart it. The caller of this API must be granted the PassRole permission on the IAM role by a permissions policy. For more information about roles, go to Working with Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html).

func (*Client) AddUserToGroup

func (c *Client) AddUserToGroup(ctx context.Context, params *AddUserToGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AddUserToGroupOutput, error)

Adds the specified user to the specified group.

func (*Client) AttachGroupPolicy

func (c *Client) AttachGroupPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *AttachGroupPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AttachGroupPolicyOutput, error)

Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified IAM group. You use this API to attach a managed policy to a group. To embed an inline policy in a group, use PutGroupPolicy. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) AttachRolePolicy

func (c *Client) AttachRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *AttachRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AttachRolePolicyOutput, error)

Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified IAM role. When you attach a managed policy to a role, the managed policy becomes part of the role's permission (access) policy. You cannot use a managed policy as the role's trust policy. The role's trust policy is created at the same time as the role, using CreateRole. You can update a role's trust policy using UpdateAssumeRolePolicy. Use this API to attach a managed policy to a role. To embed an inline policy in a role, use PutRolePolicy. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) AttachUserPolicy

func (c *Client) AttachUserPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *AttachUserPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*AttachUserPolicyOutput, error)

Attaches the specified managed policy to the specified user. You use this API to attach a managed policy to a user. To embed an inline policy in a user, use PutUserPolicy. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ChangePassword

func (c *Client) ChangePassword(ctx context.Context, params *ChangePasswordInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ChangePasswordOutput, error)

Changes the password of the IAM user who is calling this operation. The AWS account root user password is not affected by this operation. To change the password for a different user, see UpdateLoginProfile. For more information about modifying passwords, see Managing Passwords (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateAccessKey

func (c *Client) CreateAccessKey(ctx context.Context, params *CreateAccessKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateAccessKeyOutput, error)

Creates a new AWS secret access key and corresponding AWS access key ID for the specified user. The default status for new keys is Active. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials. This is true even if the AWS account has no associated users. The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide. To ensure the security of your AWS account, the secret access key is accessible only during key and user creation. You must save the key (for example, in a text file) if you want to be able to access it again. If a secret key is lost, you can delete the access keys for the associated user and then create new keys.

func (*Client) CreateAccountAlias

func (c *Client) CreateAccountAlias(ctx context.Context, params *CreateAccountAliasInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateAccountAliasOutput, error)

Creates an alias for your AWS account. For information about using an AWS account alias, see Using an Alias for Your AWS Account ID (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateGroup

func (c *Client) CreateGroup(ctx context.Context, params *CreateGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateGroupOutput, error)

Creates a new group. The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateInstanceProfile

func (c *Client) CreateInstanceProfile(ctx context.Context, params *CreateInstanceProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateInstanceProfileOutput, error)

Creates a new instance profile. For information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateLoginProfile

func (c *Client) CreateLoginProfile(ctx context.Context, params *CreateLoginProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateLoginProfileOutput, error)

Creates a password for the specified user, giving the user the ability to access AWS services through the AWS Management Console. For more information about managing passwords, see Managing Passwords (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateOpenIDConnectProvider

func (c *Client) CreateOpenIDConnectProvider(ctx context.Context, params *CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error)

Creates an IAM entity to describe an identity provider (IdP) that supports OpenID Connect (OIDC) (http://openid.net/connect/). The OIDC provider that you create with this operation can be used as a principal in a role's trust policy. Such a policy establishes a trust relationship between AWS and the OIDC provider. When you create the IAM OIDC provider, you specify the following:

* The URL of the OIDC identity provider (IdP) to trust

* A list of client IDs (also known as audiences) that identify the application or applications that are allowed to authenticate using the OIDC provider

* A list of thumbprints of one or more server certificates that the IdP uses

You get all of this information from the OIDC IdP that you want to use to access AWS. The trust for the OIDC provider is derived from the IAM provider that this operation creates. Therefore, it is best to limit access to the CreateOpenIDConnectProvider operation to highly privileged users.

func (*Client) CreatePolicy

func (c *Client) CreatePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *CreatePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreatePolicyOutput, error)

Creates a new managed policy for your AWS account. This operation creates a policy version with a version identifier of v1 and sets v1 as the policy's default version. For more information about policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) in the IAM User Guide. For more information about managed policies in general, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreatePolicyVersion

func (c *Client) CreatePolicyVersion(ctx context.Context, params *CreatePolicyVersionInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreatePolicyVersionOutput, error)

Creates a new version of the specified managed policy. To update a managed policy, you create a new policy version. A managed policy can have up to five versions. If the policy has five versions, you must delete an existing version using DeletePolicyVersion before you create a new version. Optionally, you can set the new version as the policy's default version. The default version is the version that is in effect for the IAM users, groups, and roles to which the policy is attached. For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateRole

func (c *Client) CreateRole(ctx context.Context, params *CreateRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateRoleOutput, error)

Creates a new role for your AWS account. For more information about roles, go to IAM Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateSAMLProvider

func (c *Client) CreateSAMLProvider(ctx context.Context, params *CreateSAMLProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateSAMLProviderOutput, error)

Creates an IAM resource that describes an identity provider (IdP) that supports SAML 2.0. The SAML provider resource that you create with this operation can be used as a principal in an IAM role's trust policy. Such a policy can enable federated users who sign in using the SAML IdP to assume the role. You can create an IAM role that supports Web-based single sign-on (SSO) to the AWS Management Console or one that supports API access to AWS. When you create the SAML provider resource, you upload a SAML metadata document that you get from your IdP. That document includes the issuer's name, expiration information, and keys that can be used to validate the SAML authentication response (assertions) that the IdP sends. You must generate the metadata document using the identity management software that is used as your organization's IdP. This operation requires Signature Version 4 (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html). For more information, see Enabling SAML 2.0 Federated Users to Access the AWS Management Console (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_enable-console-saml.html) and About SAML 2.0-based Federation (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_saml.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateServiceLinkedRole

func (c *Client) CreateServiceLinkedRole(ctx context.Context, params *CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error)

Creates an IAM role that is linked to a specific AWS service. The service controls the attached policies and when the role can be deleted. This helps ensure that the service is not broken by an unexpectedly changed or deleted role, which could put your AWS resources into an unknown state. Allowing the service to control the role helps improve service stability and proper cleanup when a service and its role are no longer needed. For more information, see Using Service-Linked Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/using-service-linked-roles.html) in the IAM User Guide. To attach a policy to this service-linked role, you must make the request using the AWS service that depends on this role.

func (*Client) CreateServiceSpecificCredential

func (c *Client) CreateServiceSpecificCredential(ctx context.Context, params *CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error)

Generates a set of credentials consisting of a user name and password that can be used to access the service specified in the request. These credentials are generated by IAM, and can be used only for the specified service. You can have a maximum of two sets of service-specific credentials for each supported service per user. The only supported service at this time is AWS CodeCommit. You can reset the password to a new service-generated value by calling ResetServiceSpecificCredential. For more information about service-specific credentials, see Using IAM with AWS CodeCommit: Git Credentials, SSH Keys, and AWS Access Keys (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_ssh-keys.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateUser

func (c *Client) CreateUser(ctx context.Context, params *CreateUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateUserOutput, error)

Creates a new IAM user for your AWS account. The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) CreateVirtualMFADevice

func (c *Client) CreateVirtualMFADevice(ctx context.Context, params *CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error)

Creates a new virtual MFA device for the AWS account. After creating the virtual MFA, use EnableMFADevice to attach the MFA device to an IAM user. For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, go to Using a Virtual MFA Device (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) in the IAM User Guide. The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide. The seed information contained in the QR code and the Base32 string should be treated like any other secret access information. In other words, protect the seed information as you would your AWS access keys or your passwords. After you provision your virtual device, you should ensure that the information is destroyed following secure procedures.

func (*Client) DeactivateMFADevice

func (c *Client) DeactivateMFADevice(ctx context.Context, params *DeactivateMFADeviceInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeactivateMFADeviceOutput, error)

Deactivates the specified MFA device and removes it from association with the user name for which it was originally enabled. For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, go to Enabling a Virtual Multi-factor Authentication (MFA) Device (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteAccessKey

func (c *Client) DeleteAccessKey(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteAccessKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteAccessKeyOutput, error)

Deletes the access key pair associated with the specified IAM user. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users.

func (*Client) DeleteAccountAlias

func (c *Client) DeleteAccountAlias(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteAccountAliasInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteAccountAliasOutput, error)

Deletes the specified AWS account alias. For information about using an AWS account alias, see Using an Alias for Your AWS Account ID (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy

func (c *Client) DeleteAccountPasswordPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error)

Deletes the password policy for the AWS account. There are no parameters.

func (*Client) DeleteGroup

func (c *Client) DeleteGroup(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteGroupOutput, error)

Deletes the specified IAM group. The group must not contain any users or have any attached policies.

func (*Client) DeleteGroupPolicy

func (c *Client) DeleteGroupPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteGroupPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteGroupPolicyOutput, error)

Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM group. A group can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed policy from a group, use DetachGroupPolicy. For more information about policies, refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteInstanceProfile

func (c *Client) DeleteInstanceProfile(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteInstanceProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteInstanceProfileOutput, error)

Deletes the specified instance profile. The instance profile must not have an associated role. Make sure that you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the instance profile you are about to delete. Deleting a role or instance profile that is associated with a running instance will break any applications running on the instance. For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html).

func (*Client) DeleteLoginProfile

func (c *Client) DeleteLoginProfile(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteLoginProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteLoginProfileOutput, error)

Deletes the password for the specified IAM user, which terminates the user's ability to access AWS services through the AWS Management Console. Deleting a user's password does not prevent a user from accessing AWS through the command line interface or the API. To prevent all user access, you must also either make any access keys inactive or delete them. For more information about making keys inactive or deleting them, see UpdateAccessKey and DeleteAccessKey.

func (*Client) DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider

func (c *Client) DeleteOpenIDConnectProvider(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error)

Deletes an OpenID Connect identity provider (IdP) resource object in IAM. Deleting an IAM OIDC provider resource does not update any roles that reference the provider as a principal in their trust policies. Any attempt to assume a role that references a deleted provider fails. This operation is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you call the operation for a provider that does not exist.

func (*Client) DeletePolicy

func (c *Client) DeletePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DeletePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeletePolicyOutput, error)

Deletes the specified managed policy. Before you can delete a managed policy, you must first detach the policy from all users, groups, and roles that it is attached to. In addition, you must delete all the policy's versions. The following steps describe the process for deleting a managed policy:

* Detach the policy from all users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached to, using the DetachUserPolicy, DetachGroupPolicy, or DetachRolePolicy API operations. To list all the users, groups, and roles that a policy is attached to, use ListEntitiesForPolicy.

* Delete all versions of the policy using DeletePolicyVersion. To list the policy's versions, use ListPolicyVersions. You cannot use DeletePolicyVersion to delete the version that is marked as the default version. You delete the policy's default version in the next step of the process.

* Delete the policy (this automatically deletes the policy's default version) using this API.

For information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeletePolicyVersion

func (c *Client) DeletePolicyVersion(ctx context.Context, params *DeletePolicyVersionInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeletePolicyVersionOutput, error)

Deletes the specified version from the specified managed policy. You cannot delete the default version from a policy using this API. To delete the default version from a policy, use DeletePolicy. To find out which version of a policy is marked as the default version, use ListPolicyVersions. For information about versions for managed policies, see Versioning for Managed Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteRole

func (c *Client) DeleteRole(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteRoleOutput, error)

Deletes the specified role. The role must not have any policies attached. For more information about roles, go to Working with Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). Make sure that you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the role you are about to delete. Deleting a role or instance profile that is associated with a running instance will break any applications running on the instance.

func (*Client) DeleteRolePermissionsBoundary

func (c *Client) DeleteRolePermissionsBoundary(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput, error)

Deletes the permissions boundary for the specified IAM role. Deleting the permissions boundary for a role might increase its permissions. For example, it might allow anyone who assumes the role to perform all the actions granted in its permissions policies.

func (*Client) DeleteRolePolicy

func (c *Client) DeleteRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteRolePolicyOutput, error)

Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM role. A role can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed policy from a role, use DetachRolePolicy. For more information about policies, refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteSAMLProvider

func (c *Client) DeleteSAMLProvider(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteSAMLProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteSAMLProviderOutput, error)

Deletes a SAML provider resource in IAM. Deleting the provider resource from IAM does not update any roles that reference the SAML provider resource's ARN as a principal in their trust policies. Any attempt to assume a role that references a non-existent provider resource ARN fails. This operation requires Signature Version 4 (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).

func (*Client) DeleteSSHPublicKey

func (c *Client) DeleteSSHPublicKey(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput, error)

Deletes the specified SSH public key. The SSH public key deleted by this operation is used only for authenticating the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteServerCertificate

func (c *Client) DeleteServerCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteServerCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteServerCertificateOutput, error)

Deletes the specified server certificate. For more information about working with server certificates, see Working with Server Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) in the IAM User Guide. This topic also includes a list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage with IAM. If you are using a server certificate with Elastic Load Balancing, deleting the certificate could have implications for your application. If Elastic Load Balancing doesn't detect the deletion of bound certificates, it may continue to use the certificates. This could cause Elastic Load Balancing to stop accepting traffic. We recommend that you remove the reference to the certificate from Elastic Load Balancing before using this command to delete the certificate. For more information, go to DeleteLoadBalancerListeners (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/ElasticLoadBalancing/latest/APIReference/API_DeleteLoadBalancerListeners.html) in the Elastic Load Balancing API Reference.

func (*Client) DeleteServiceLinkedRole

func (c *Client) DeleteServiceLinkedRole(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput, error)

Submits a service-linked role deletion request and returns a DeletionTaskId, which you can use to check the status of the deletion. Before you call this operation, confirm that the role has no active sessions and that any resources used by the role in the linked service are deleted. If you call this operation more than once for the same service-linked role and an earlier deletion task is not complete, then the DeletionTaskId of the earlier request is returned. If you submit a deletion request for a service-linked role whose linked service is still accessing a resource, then the deletion task fails. If it fails, the GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus API operation returns the reason for the failure, usually including the resources that must be deleted. To delete the service-linked role, you must first remove those resources from the linked service and then submit the deletion request again. Resources are specific to the service that is linked to the role. For more information about removing resources from a service, see the AWS documentation (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/) for your service. For more information about service-linked roles, see Roles Terms and Concepts: AWS Service-Linked Role (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_terms-and-concepts.html#iam-term-service-linked-role) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteServiceSpecificCredential

func (c *Client) DeleteServiceSpecificCredential(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error)

Deletes the specified service-specific credential.

func (*Client) DeleteSigningCertificate

func (c *Client) DeleteSigningCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteSigningCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteSigningCertificateOutput, error)

Deletes a signing certificate associated with the specified IAM user. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly based on the AWS access key ID signing the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated IAM users.

func (*Client) DeleteUser

func (c *Client) DeleteUser(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteUserOutput, error)

Deletes the specified IAM user. Unlike the AWS Management Console, when you delete a user programmatically, you must delete the items attached to the user manually, or the deletion fails. For more information, see Deleting an IAM User (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_users_manage.html#id_users_deleting_cli). Before attempting to delete a user, remove the following items:

* Password (DeleteLoginProfile)

* Access keys (DeleteAccessKey)

* Signing certificate (DeleteSigningCertificate)

* SSH public key (DeleteSSHPublicKey)

* Git credentials (DeleteServiceSpecificCredential)

* Multi-factor authentication (MFA) device (DeactivateMFADevice, DeleteVirtualMFADevice)

* Inline policies (DeleteUserPolicy)

* Attached managed policies (DetachUserPolicy)

* Group memberships (RemoveUserFromGroup)

func (*Client) DeleteUserPermissionsBoundary

func (c *Client) DeleteUserPermissionsBoundary(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput, error)

Deletes the permissions boundary for the specified IAM user. Deleting the permissions boundary for a user might increase its permissions by allowing the user to perform all the actions granted in its permissions policies.

func (*Client) DeleteUserPolicy

func (c *Client) DeleteUserPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteUserPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteUserPolicyOutput, error)

Deletes the specified inline policy that is embedded in the specified IAM user. A user can also have managed policies attached to it. To detach a managed policy from a user, use DetachUserPolicy. For more information about policies, refer to Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DeleteVirtualMFADevice

func (c *Client) DeleteVirtualMFADevice(ctx context.Context, params *DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput, error)

Deletes a virtual MFA device. You must deactivate a user's virtual MFA device before you can delete it. For information about deactivating MFA devices, see DeactivateMFADevice.

func (*Client) DetachGroupPolicy

func (c *Client) DetachGroupPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DetachGroupPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DetachGroupPolicyOutput, error)

Removes the specified managed policy from the specified IAM group. A group can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline policy, use the DeleteGroupPolicy API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DetachRolePolicy

func (c *Client) DetachRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DetachRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DetachRolePolicyOutput, error)

Removes the specified managed policy from the specified role. A role can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline policy, use the DeleteRolePolicy API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) DetachUserPolicy

func (c *Client) DetachUserPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *DetachUserPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*DetachUserPolicyOutput, error)

Removes the specified managed policy from the specified user. A user can also have inline policies embedded with it. To delete an inline policy, use the DeleteUserPolicy API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) EnableMFADevice

func (c *Client) EnableMFADevice(ctx context.Context, params *EnableMFADeviceInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*EnableMFADeviceOutput, error)

Enables the specified MFA device and associates it with the specified IAM user. When enabled, the MFA device is required for every subsequent login by the IAM user associated with the device.

func (*Client) GenerateCredentialReport

func (c *Client) GenerateCredentialReport(ctx context.Context, params *GenerateCredentialReportInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GenerateCredentialReportOutput, error)

Generates a credential report for the AWS account. For more information about the credential report, see Getting Credential Reports (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GenerateOrganizationsAccessReport

func (c *Client) GenerateOrganizationsAccessReport(ctx context.Context, params *GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportOutput, error)

Generates a report for service last accessed data for AWS Organizations. You can generate a report for any entities (organization root, organizational unit, or account) or policies in your organization. To call this operation, you must be signed in using your AWS Organizations master account credentials. You can use your long-term IAM user or root user credentials, or temporary credentials from assuming an IAM role. SCPs must be enabled for your organization root. You must have the required IAM and AWS Organizations permissions. For more information, see Refining Permissions Using Service Last Accessed Data (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can generate a service last accessed data report for entities by specifying only the entity's path. This data includes a list of services that are allowed by any service control policies (SCPs) that apply to the entity. You can generate a service last accessed data report for a policy by specifying an entity's path and an optional AWS Organizations policy ID. This data includes a list of services that are allowed by the specified SCP. For each service in both report types, the data includes the most recent account activity that the policy allows to account principals in the entity or the entity's children. For important information about the data, reporting period, permissions required, troubleshooting, and supported Regions see Reducing Permissions Using Service Last Accessed Data (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide. The data includes all attempts to access AWS, not just the successful ones. This includes all attempts that were made using the AWS Management Console, the AWS API through any of the SDKs, or any of the command line tools. An unexpected entry in the service last accessed data does not mean that an account has been compromised, because the request might have been denied. Refer to your CloudTrail logs as the authoritative source for information about all API calls and whether they were successful or denied access. For more information, see Logging IAM Events with CloudTrail (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/cloudtrail-integration.html) in the IAM User Guide. This operation returns a JobId. Use this parameter in the GetOrganizationsAccessReport operation to check the status of the report generation. To check the status of this request, use the JobId parameter in the GetOrganizationsAccessReport operation and test the JobStatus response parameter. When the job is complete, you can retrieve the report. To generate a service last accessed data report for entities, specify an entity path without specifying the optional AWS Organizations policy ID. The type of entity that you specify determines the data returned in the report.

* Root – When you specify the organizations root as the entity, the resulting report lists all of the services allowed by SCPs that are attached to your root. For each service, the report includes data for all accounts in your organization except the master account, because the master account is not limited by SCPs.

* OU – When you specify an organizational unit (OU) as the entity, the resulting report lists all of the services allowed by SCPs that are attached to the OU and its parents. For each service, the report includes data for all accounts in the OU or its children. This data excludes the master account, because the master account is not limited by SCPs.

* Master account – When you specify the master account, the resulting report lists all AWS services, because the master account is not limited by SCPs. For each service, the report includes data for only the master account.

* Account – When you specify another account as the entity, the resulting report lists all of the services allowed by SCPs that are attached to the account and its parents. For each service, the report includes data for only the specified account.

To generate a service last accessed data report for policies, specify an entity path and the optional AWS Organizations policy ID. The type of entity that you specify determines the data returned for each service.

* Root – When you specify the root entity and a policy ID, the resulting report lists all of the services that are allowed by the specified SCP. For each service, the report includes data for all accounts in your organization to which the SCP applies. This data excludes the master account, because the master account is not limited by SCPs. If the SCP is not attached to any entities in the organization, then the report will return a list of services with no data.

* OU – When you specify an OU entity and a policy ID, the resulting report lists all of the services that are allowed by the specified SCP. For each service, the report includes data for all accounts in the OU or its children to which the SCP applies. This means that other accounts outside the OU that are affected by the SCP might not be included in the data. This data excludes the master account, because the master account is not limited by SCPs. If the SCP is not attached to the OU or one of its children, the report will return a list of services with no data.

* Master account – When you specify the master account, the resulting report lists all AWS services, because the master account is not limited by SCPs. If you specify a policy ID in the CLI or API, the policy is ignored. For each service, the report includes data for only the master account.

* Account – When you specify another account entity and a policy ID, the resulting report lists all of the services that are allowed by the specified SCP. For each service, the report includes data for only the specified account. This means that other accounts in the organization that are affected by the SCP might not be included in the data. If the SCP is not attached to the account, the report will return a list of services with no data.

Service last accessed data does not use other policy types when determining whether a principal could access a service. These other policy types include identity-based policies, resource-based policies, access control lists, IAM permissions boundaries, and STS assume role policies. It only applies SCP logic. For more about the evaluation of policy types, see Evaluating Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html#policy-eval-basics) in the IAM User Guide. For more information about service last accessed data, see Reducing Policy Scope by Viewing User Activity (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails

func (c *Client) GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails(ctx context.Context, params *GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput, error)

Generates a report that includes details about when an IAM resource (user, group, role, or policy) was last used in an attempt to access AWS services. Recent activity usually appears within four hours. IAM reports activity for the last 365 days, or less if your Region began supporting this feature within the last year. For more information, see Regions Where Data Is Tracked (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html#access-advisor_tracking-period). The service last accessed data includes all attempts to access an AWS API, not just the successful ones. This includes all attempts that were made using the AWS Management Console, the AWS API through any of the SDKs, or any of the command line tools. An unexpected entry in the service last accessed data does not mean that your account has been compromised, because the request might have been denied. Refer to your CloudTrail logs as the authoritative source for information about all API calls and whether they were successful or denied access. For more information, see Logging IAM Events with CloudTrail (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/cloudtrail-integration.html) in the IAM User Guide. The GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails operation returns a JobId. Use this parameter in the following operations to retrieve the following details from your report:

* GetServiceLastAccessedDetails – Use this operation for users, groups, roles, or policies to list every AWS service that the resource could access using permissions policies. For each service, the response includes information about the most recent access attempt. The JobId returned by GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetail must be used by the same role within a session, or by the same user when used to call GetServiceLastAccessedDetail.

* GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities – Use this operation for groups and policies to list information about the associated entities (users or roles) that attempted to access a specific AWS service.

To check the status of the GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails request, use the JobId parameter in the same operations and test the JobStatus response parameter. For additional information about the permissions policies that allow an identity (user, group, or role) to access specific services, use the ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccess operation. Service last accessed data does not use other policy types when determining whether a resource could access a service. These other policy types include resource-based policies, access control lists, AWS Organizations policies, IAM permissions boundaries, and AWS STS assume role policies. It only applies permissions policy logic. For more about the evaluation of policy types, see Evaluating Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html#policy-eval-basics) in the IAM User Guide. For more information about service and action last accessed data, see Reducing Permissions Using Service Last Accessed Data (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetAccessKeyLastUsed

func (c *Client) GetAccessKeyLastUsed(ctx context.Context, params *GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput, error)

Retrieves information about when the specified access key was last used. The information includes the date and time of last use, along with the AWS service and Region that were specified in the last request made with that key.

func (*Client) GetAccountAuthorizationDetails

func (c *Client) GetAccountAuthorizationDetails(ctx context.Context, params *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, error)

Retrieves information about all IAM users, groups, roles, and policies in your AWS account, including their relationships to one another. Use this API to obtain a snapshot of the configuration of IAM permissions (users, groups, roles, and policies) in your account. Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality. You can optionally filter the results using the Filter parameter. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) GetAccountPasswordPolicy

func (c *Client) GetAccountPasswordPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error)

Retrieves the password policy for the AWS account. For more information about using a password policy, go to Managing an IAM Password Policy (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingPasswordPolicies.html).

func (*Client) GetAccountSummary

func (c *Client) GetAccountSummary(ctx context.Context, params *GetAccountSummaryInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetAccountSummaryOutput, error)

Retrieves information about IAM entity usage and IAM quotas in the AWS account. The number and size of IAM resources in an AWS account are limited. For more information, see IAM and STS Quotas (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-quotas.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy

func (c *Client) GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyOutput, error)

Gets a list of all of the context keys referenced in the input policies. The policies are supplied as a list of one or more strings. To get the context keys from policies associated with an IAM user, group, or role, use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide details about the context of an API query request. Context keys can be evaluated by testing against a value specified in an IAM policy. Use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy to understand what key names and values you must supply when you call SimulateCustomPolicy. Note that all parameters are shown in unencoded form here for clarity but must be URL encoded to be included as a part of a real HTML request.

func (*Client) GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy

func (c *Client) GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyOutput, error)

Gets a list of all of the context keys referenced in all the IAM policies that are attached to the specified IAM entity. The entity can be an IAM user, group, or role. If you specify a user, then the request also includes all of the policies attached to groups that the user is a member of. You can optionally include a list of one or more additional policies, specified as strings. If you want to include only a list of policies by string, use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy instead. Note: This API discloses information about the permissions granted to other users. If you do not want users to see other user's permissions, then consider allowing them to use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy instead. Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide details about the context of an API query request. Context keys can be evaluated by testing against a value in an IAM policy. Use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy to understand what key names and values you must supply when you call SimulatePrincipalPolicy.

func (*Client) GetCredentialReport

func (c *Client) GetCredentialReport(ctx context.Context, params *GetCredentialReportInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetCredentialReportOutput, error)

Retrieves a credential report for the AWS account. For more information about the credential report, see Getting Credential Reports (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/credential-reports.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetGroup

func (c *Client) GetGroup(ctx context.Context, params *GetGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetGroupOutput, error)

Returns a list of IAM users that are in the specified IAM group. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) GetGroupPolicy

func (c *Client) GetGroupPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetGroupPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetGroupPolicyOutput, error)

Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded in the specified IAM group. Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality. An IAM group can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a managed policy document that is attached to a group, use GetPolicy to determine the policy's default version, then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy document. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetInstanceProfile

func (c *Client) GetInstanceProfile(ctx context.Context, params *GetInstanceProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetInstanceProfileOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified instance profile, including the instance profile's path, GUID, ARN, and role. For more information about instance profiles, see About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetLoginProfile

func (c *Client) GetLoginProfile(ctx context.Context, params *GetLoginProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetLoginProfileOutput, error)

Retrieves the user name and password-creation date for the specified IAM user. If the user has not been assigned a password, the operation returns a 404 (NoSuchEntity) error.

func (*Client) GetOpenIDConnectProvider

func (c *Client) GetOpenIDConnectProvider(ctx context.Context, params *GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error)

Returns information about the specified OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource object in IAM.

func (*Client) GetOrganizationsAccessReport

func (c *Client) GetOrganizationsAccessReport(ctx context.Context, params *GetOrganizationsAccessReportInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetOrganizationsAccessReportOutput, error)

Retrieves the service last accessed data report for AWS Organizations that was previously generated using the GenerateOrganizationsAccessReport operation. This operation retrieves the status of your report job and the report contents. Depending on the parameters that you passed when you generated the report, the data returned could include different information. For details, see GenerateOrganizationsAccessReport. To call this operation, you must be signed in to the master account in your organization. SCPs must be enabled for your organization root. You must have permissions to perform this operation. For more information, see Refining Permissions Using Service Last Accessed Data (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide. For each service that principals in an account (root users, IAM users, or IAM roles) could access using SCPs, the operation returns details about the most recent access attempt. If there was no attempt, the service is listed without details about the most recent attempt to access the service. If the operation fails, it returns the reason that it failed. By default, the list is sorted by service namespace.

func (*Client) GetPolicy

func (c *Client) GetPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetPolicyOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified managed policy, including the policy's default version and the total number of IAM users, groups, and roles to which the policy is attached. To retrieve the list of the specific users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached to, use the ListEntitiesForPolicy API. This API returns metadata about the policy. To retrieve the actual policy document for a specific version of the policy, use GetPolicyVersion. This API retrieves information about managed policies. To retrieve information about an inline policy that is embedded with an IAM user, group, or role, use the GetUserPolicy, GetGroupPolicy, or GetRolePolicy API. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetPolicyVersion

func (c *Client) GetPolicyVersion(ctx context.Context, params *GetPolicyVersionInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetPolicyVersionOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified version of the specified managed policy, including the policy document. Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality. To list the available versions for a policy, use ListPolicyVersions. This API retrieves information about managed policies. To retrieve information about an inline policy that is embedded in a user, group, or role, use the GetUserPolicy, GetGroupPolicy, or GetRolePolicy API. For more information about the types of policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. For more information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetRole

func (c *Client) GetRole(ctx context.Context, params *GetRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetRoleOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified role, including the role's path, GUID, ARN, and the role's trust policy that grants permission to assume the role. For more information about roles, see Working with Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality.

func (*Client) GetRolePolicy

func (c *Client) GetRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetRolePolicyOutput, error)

Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded with the specified IAM role. Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality. An IAM role can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a managed policy document that is attached to a role, use GetPolicy to determine the policy's default version, then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy document. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. For more information about roles, see Using Roles to Delegate Permissions and Federate Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html).

func (*Client) GetSAMLProvider

func (c *Client) GetSAMLProvider(ctx context.Context, params *GetSAMLProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetSAMLProviderOutput, error)

Returns the SAML provider metadocument that was uploaded when the IAM SAML provider resource object was created or updated. This operation requires Signature Version 4 (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).

func (*Client) GetSSHPublicKey

func (c *Client) GetSSHPublicKey(ctx context.Context, params *GetSSHPublicKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetSSHPublicKeyOutput, error)

Retrieves the specified SSH public key, including metadata about the key. The SSH public key retrieved by this operation is used only for authenticating the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide.

func (*Client) GetServerCertificate

func (c *Client) GetServerCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *GetServerCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetServerCertificateOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified server certificate stored in IAM. For more information about working with server certificates, see Working with Server Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) in the IAM User Guide. This topic includes a list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage with IAM.

func (*Client) GetServiceLastAccessedDetails

func (c *Client) GetServiceLastAccessedDetails(ctx context.Context, params *GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput, error)

Retrieves a service last accessed report that was created using the GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails operation. You can use the JobId parameter in GetServiceLastAccessedDetails to retrieve the status of your report job. When the report is complete, you can retrieve the generated report. The report includes a list of AWS services that the resource (user, group, role, or managed policy) can access. Service last accessed data does not use other policy types when determining whether a resource could access a service. These other policy types include resource-based policies, access control lists, AWS Organizations policies, IAM permissions boundaries, and AWS STS assume role policies. It only applies permissions policy logic. For more about the evaluation of policy types, see Evaluating Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html#policy-eval-basics) in the IAM User Guide. For each service that the resource could access using permissions policies, the operation returns details about the most recent access attempt. If there was no attempt, the service is listed without details about the most recent attempt to access the service. If the operation fails, the GetServiceLastAccessedDetails operation returns the reason that it failed. The GetServiceLastAccessedDetails operation returns a list of services. This list includes the number of entities that have attempted to access the service and the date and time of the last attempt. It also returns the ARN of the following entity, depending on the resource ARN that you used to generate the report:

* User – Returns the user ARN that you used to generate the report

* Group – Returns the ARN of the group member (user) that last attempted to access the service

* Role – Returns the role ARN that you used to generate the report

* Policy – Returns the ARN of the user or role that last used the policy to attempt to access the service

By default, the list is sorted by service namespace. If you specified ACTION_LEVEL granularity when you generated the report, this operation returns service and action last accessed data. This includes the most recent access attempt for each tracked action within a service. Otherwise, this operation returns only service data. For more information about service and action last accessed data, see Reducing Permissions Using Service Last Accessed Data (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_access-advisor.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities

func (c *Client) GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities(ctx context.Context, params *GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesOutput, error)

After you generate a group or policy report using the GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails operation, you can use the JobId parameter in GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities. This operation retrieves the status of your report job and a list of entities that could have used group or policy permissions to access the specified service.

* Group – For a group report, this operation returns a list of users in the group that could have used the group’s policies in an attempt to access the service.

* Policy – For a policy report, this operation returns a list of entities (users or roles) that could have used the policy in an attempt to access the service.

You can also use this operation for user or role reports to retrieve details about those entities. If the operation fails, the GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities operation returns the reason that it failed. By default, the list of associated entities is sorted by date, with the most recent access listed first.

func (*Client) GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus

func (c *Client) GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus(ctx context.Context, params *GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput, error)

Retrieves the status of your service-linked role deletion. After you use the DeleteServiceLinkedRole API operation to submit a service-linked role for deletion, you can use the DeletionTaskId parameter in GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatus to check the status of the deletion. If the deletion fails, this operation returns the reason that it failed, if that information is returned by the service.

func (*Client) GetUser

func (c *Client) GetUser(ctx context.Context, params *GetUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetUserOutput, error)

Retrieves information about the specified IAM user, including the user's creation date, path, unique ID, and ARN. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request to this API.

func (*Client) GetUserPolicy

func (c *Client) GetUserPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *GetUserPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetUserPolicyOutput, error)

Retrieves the specified inline policy document that is embedded in the specified IAM user. Policies returned by this API are URL-encoded compliant with RFC 3986 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3986). You can use a URL decoding method to convert the policy back to plain JSON text. For example, if you use Java, you can use the decode method of the java.net.URLDecoder utility class in the Java SDK. Other languages and SDKs provide similar functionality. An IAM user can also have managed policies attached to it. To retrieve a managed policy document that is attached to a user, use GetPolicy to determine the policy's default version. Then use GetPolicyVersion to retrieve the policy document. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListAccessKeys

func (c *Client) ListAccessKeys(ctx context.Context, params *ListAccessKeysInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccessKeysOutput, error)

Returns information about the access key IDs associated with the specified IAM user. If there is none, the operation returns an empty list. Although each user is limited to a small number of keys, you can still paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If the UserName field is not specified, the user name is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. To ensure the security of your AWS account, the secret access key is accessible only during key and user creation.

func (*Client) ListAccountAliases

func (c *Client) ListAccountAliases(ctx context.Context, params *ListAccountAliasesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccountAliasesOutput, error)

Lists the account alias associated with the AWS account (Note: you can have only one). For information about using an AWS account alias, see Using an Alias for Your AWS Account ID (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AccountAlias.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListAttachedGroupPolicies

func (c *Client) ListAttachedGroupPolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, error)

Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM group. An IAM group can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the inline policies for a group, use the ListGroupPolicies API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to the specified group (or none that match the specified path prefix), the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListAttachedRolePolicies

func (c *Client) ListAttachedRolePolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, error)

Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM role. An IAM role can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the inline policies for a role, use the ListRolePolicies API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to the specified role (or none that match the specified path prefix), the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListAttachedUserPolicies

func (c *Client) ListAttachedUserPolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, error)

Lists all managed policies that are attached to the specified IAM user. An IAM user can also have inline policies embedded with it. To list the inline policies for a user, use the ListUserPolicies API. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. You can use the PathPrefix parameter to limit the list of policies to only those matching the specified path prefix. If there are no policies attached to the specified group (or none that match the specified path prefix), the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListEntitiesForPolicy

func (c *Client) ListEntitiesForPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, error)

Lists all IAM users, groups, and roles that the specified managed policy is attached to. You can use the optional EntityFilter parameter to limit the results to a particular type of entity (users, groups, or roles). For example, to list only the roles that are attached to the specified policy, set EntityFilter to Role. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListGroupPolicies

func (c *Client) ListGroupPolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListGroupPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, error)

Lists the names of the inline policies that are embedded in the specified IAM group. An IAM group can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed policies that are attached to a group, use ListAttachedGroupPolicies. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If there are no inline policies embedded with the specified group, the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListGroups

func (c *Client) ListGroups(ctx context.Context, params *ListGroupsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsOutput, error)

Lists the IAM groups that have the specified path prefix. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListGroupsForUser

func (c *Client) ListGroupsForUser(ctx context.Context, params *ListGroupsForUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsForUserOutput, error)

Lists the IAM groups that the specified IAM user belongs to. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListInstanceProfiles

func (c *Client) ListInstanceProfiles(ctx context.Context, params *ListInstanceProfilesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, error)

Lists the instance profiles that have the specified path prefix. If there are none, the operation returns an empty list. For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListInstanceProfilesForRole

func (c *Client) ListInstanceProfilesForRole(ctx context.Context, params *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, error)

Lists the instance profiles that have the specified associated IAM role. If there are none, the operation returns an empty list. For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html). You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListMFADevices

func (c *Client) ListMFADevices(ctx context.Context, params *ListMFADevicesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListMFADevicesOutput, error)

Lists the MFA devices for an IAM user. If the request includes a IAM user name, then this operation lists all the MFA devices associated with the specified user. If you do not specify a user name, IAM determines the user name implicitly based on the AWS access key ID signing the request for this API. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListOpenIDConnectProviders

func (c *Client) ListOpenIDConnectProviders(ctx context.Context, params *ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput, error)

Lists information about the IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource objects defined in the AWS account.

func (*Client) ListPolicies

func (c *Client) ListPolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListPoliciesOutput, error)

Lists all the managed policies that are available in your AWS account, including your own customer-defined managed policies and all AWS managed policies. You can filter the list of policies that is returned using the optional OnlyAttached, Scope, and PathPrefix parameters. For example, to list only the customer managed policies in your AWS account, set Scope to Local. To list only AWS managed policies, set Scope to AWS. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. For more information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccess

func (c *Client) ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccess(ctx context.Context, params *ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessOutput, error)

Retrieves a list of policies that the IAM identity (user, group, or role) can use to access each specified service. This operation does not use other policy types when determining whether a resource could access a service. These other policy types include resource-based policies, access control lists, AWS Organizations policies, IAM permissions boundaries, and AWS STS assume role policies. It only applies permissions policy logic. For more about the evaluation of policy types, see Evaluating Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html#policy-eval-basics) in the IAM User Guide. The list of policies returned by the operation depends on the ARN of the identity that you provide.

* User – The list of policies includes the managed and inline policies that are attached to the user directly. The list also includes any additional managed and inline policies that are attached to the group to which the user belongs.

* Group – The list of policies includes only the managed and inline policies that are attached to the group directly. Policies that are attached to the group’s user are not included.

* Role – The list of policies includes only the managed and inline policies that are attached to the role.

For each managed policy, this operation returns the ARN and policy name. For each inline policy, it returns the policy name and the entity to which it is attached. Inline policies do not have an ARN. For more information about these policy types, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. Policies that are attached to users and roles as permissions boundaries are not returned. To view which managed policy is currently used to set the permissions boundary for a user or role, use the GetUser or GetRole operations.

func (*Client) ListPolicyVersions

func (c *Client) ListPolicyVersions(ctx context.Context, params *ListPolicyVersionsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, error)

Lists information about the versions of the specified managed policy, including the version that is currently set as the policy's default version. For more information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListRolePolicies

func (c *Client) ListRolePolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListRolePoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolePoliciesOutput, error)

Lists the names of the inline policies that are embedded in the specified IAM role. An IAM role can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed policies that are attached to a role, use ListAttachedRolePolicies. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If there are no inline policies embedded with the specified role, the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListRoleTags

func (c *Client) ListRoleTags(ctx context.Context, params *ListRoleTagsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListRoleTagsOutput, error)

Lists the tags that are attached to the specified role. The returned list of tags is sorted by tag key. For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListRoles

func (c *Client) ListRoles(ctx context.Context, params *ListRolesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolesOutput, error)

Lists the IAM roles that have the specified path prefix. If there are none, the operation returns an empty list. For more information about roles, go to Working with Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListSAMLProviders

func (c *Client) ListSAMLProviders(ctx context.Context, params *ListSAMLProvidersInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListSAMLProvidersOutput, error)

Lists the SAML provider resource objects defined in IAM in the account. This operation requires Signature Version 4 (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).

func (*Client) ListSSHPublicKeys

func (c *Client) ListSSHPublicKeys(ctx context.Context, params *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, error)

Returns information about the SSH public keys associated with the specified IAM user. If none exists, the operation returns an empty list. The SSH public keys returned by this operation are used only for authenticating the IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide. Although each user is limited to a small number of keys, you can still paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListServerCertificates

func (c *Client) ListServerCertificates(ctx context.Context, params *ListServerCertificatesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListServerCertificatesOutput, error)

Lists the server certificates stored in IAM that have the specified path prefix. If none exist, the operation returns an empty list. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. For more information about working with server certificates, see Working with Server Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) in the IAM User Guide. This topic also includes a list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage with IAM.

func (*Client) ListServiceSpecificCredentials

func (c *Client) ListServiceSpecificCredentials(ctx context.Context, params *ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput, error)

Returns information about the service-specific credentials associated with the specified IAM user. If none exists, the operation returns an empty list. The service-specific credentials returned by this operation are used only for authenticating the IAM user to a specific service. For more information about using service-specific credentials to authenticate to an AWS service, see Set Up service-specific credentials (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-gc.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide.

func (*Client) ListSigningCertificates

func (c *Client) ListSigningCertificates(ctx context.Context, params *ListSigningCertificatesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, error)

Returns information about the signing certificates associated with the specified IAM user. If none exists, the operation returns an empty list. Although each user is limited to a small number of signing certificates, you can still paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If the UserName field is not specified, the user name is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request for this API. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users.

func (*Client) ListUserPolicies

func (c *Client) ListUserPolicies(ctx context.Context, params *ListUserPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListUserPoliciesOutput, error)

Lists the names of the inline policies embedded in the specified IAM user. An IAM user can also have managed policies attached to it. To list the managed policies that are attached to a user, use ListAttachedUserPolicies. For more information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters. If there are no inline policies embedded with the specified user, the operation returns an empty list.

func (*Client) ListUserTags

func (c *Client) ListUserTags(ctx context.Context, params *ListUserTagsInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListUserTagsOutput, error)

Lists the tags that are attached to the specified user. The returned list of tags is sorted by tag key. For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) ListUsers

func (c *Client) ListUsers(ctx context.Context, params *ListUsersInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListUsersOutput, error)

Lists the IAM users that have the specified path prefix. If no path prefix is specified, the operation returns all users in the AWS account. If there are none, the operation returns an empty list. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) ListVirtualMFADevices

func (c *Client) ListVirtualMFADevices(ctx context.Context, params *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, error)

Lists the virtual MFA devices defined in the AWS account by assignment status. If you do not specify an assignment status, the operation returns a list of all virtual MFA devices. Assignment status can be Assigned, Unassigned, or Any. You can paginate the results using the MaxItems and Marker parameters.

func (*Client) PutGroupPolicy

func (c *Client) PutGroupPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *PutGroupPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*PutGroupPolicyOutput, error)

Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified IAM group. A user can also have managed policies attached to it. To attach a managed policy to a group, use AttachGroupPolicy. To create a new managed policy, use CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can embed in a group, see Limitations on IAM Entities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) in the IAM User Guide. Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling PutGroupPolicy. For general information about using the Query API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) PutRolePermissionsBoundary

func (c *Client) PutRolePermissionsBoundary(ctx context.Context, params *PutRolePermissionsBoundaryInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*PutRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput, error)

Adds or updates the policy that is specified as the IAM role's permissions boundary. You can use an AWS managed policy or a customer managed policy to set the boundary for a role. Use the boundary to control the maximum permissions that the role can have. Setting a permissions boundary is an advanced feature that can affect the permissions for the role. You cannot set the boundary for a service-linked role. Policies used as permissions boundaries do not provide permissions. You must also attach a permissions policy to the role. To learn how the effective permissions for a role are evaluated, see IAM JSON Policy Evaluation Logic (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) PutRolePolicy

func (c *Client) PutRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *PutRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*PutRolePolicyOutput, error)

Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified IAM role. When you embed an inline policy in a role, the inline policy is used as part of the role's access (permissions) policy. The role's trust policy is created at the same time as the role, using CreateRole. You can update a role's trust policy using UpdateAssumeRolePolicy. For more information about IAM roles, go to Using Roles to Delegate Permissions and Federate Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html). A role can also have a managed policy attached to it. To attach a managed policy to a role, use AttachRolePolicy. To create a new managed policy, use CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can embed with a role, see Limitations on IAM Entities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) in the IAM User Guide. Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling PutRolePolicy. For general information about using the Query API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) PutUserPermissionsBoundary

func (c *Client) PutUserPermissionsBoundary(ctx context.Context, params *PutUserPermissionsBoundaryInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*PutUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput, error)

Adds or updates the policy that is specified as the IAM user's permissions boundary. You can use an AWS managed policy or a customer managed policy to set the boundary for a user. Use the boundary to control the maximum permissions that the user can have. Setting a permissions boundary is an advanced feature that can affect the permissions for the user. Policies that are used as permissions boundaries do not provide permissions. You must also attach a permissions policy to the user. To learn how the effective permissions for a user are evaluated, see IAM JSON Policy Evaluation Logic (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_evaluation-logic.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) PutUserPolicy

func (c *Client) PutUserPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *PutUserPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*PutUserPolicyOutput, error)

Adds or updates an inline policy document that is embedded in the specified IAM user. An IAM user can also have a managed policy attached to it. To attach a managed policy to a user, use AttachUserPolicy. To create a new managed policy, use CreatePolicy. For information about policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide. For information about limits on the number of inline policies that you can embed in a user, see Limitations on IAM Entities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/LimitationsOnEntities.html) in the IAM User Guide. Because policy documents can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling PutUserPolicy. For general information about using the Query API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider

func (c *Client) RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProvider(ctx context.Context, params *RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput, error)

Removes the specified client ID (also known as audience) from the list of client IDs registered for the specified IAM OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource object. This operation is idempotent; it does not fail or return an error if you try to remove a client ID that does not exist.

func (*Client) RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile

func (c *Client) RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfile(ctx context.Context, params *RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput, error)

Removes the specified IAM role from the specified EC2 instance profile. Make sure that you do not have any Amazon EC2 instances running with the role you are about to remove from the instance profile. Removing a role from an instance profile that is associated with a running instance might break any applications running on the instance. For more information about IAM roles, go to Working with Roles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/WorkingWithRoles.html). For more information about instance profiles, go to About Instance Profiles (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/AboutInstanceProfiles.html).

func (*Client) RemoveUserFromGroup

func (c *Client) RemoveUserFromGroup(ctx context.Context, params *RemoveUserFromGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*RemoveUserFromGroupOutput, error)

Removes the specified user from the specified group.

func (*Client) ResetServiceSpecificCredential

func (c *Client) ResetServiceSpecificCredential(ctx context.Context, params *ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error)

Resets the password for a service-specific credential. The new password is AWS generated and cryptographically strong. It cannot be configured by the user. Resetting the password immediately invalidates the previous password associated with this user.

func (*Client) ResyncMFADevice

func (c *Client) ResyncMFADevice(ctx context.Context, params *ResyncMFADeviceInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ResyncMFADeviceOutput, error)

Synchronizes the specified MFA device with its IAM resource object on the AWS servers. For more information about creating and working with virtual MFA devices, go to Using a Virtual MFA Device (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_VirtualMFA.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) SetDefaultPolicyVersion

func (c *Client) SetDefaultPolicyVersion(ctx context.Context, params *SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput, error)

Sets the specified version of the specified policy as the policy's default (operative) version. This operation affects all users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached to. To list the users, groups, and roles that the policy is attached to, use the ListEntitiesForPolicy API. For information about managed policies, see Managed Policies and Inline Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-vs-inline.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) SetSecurityTokenServicePreferences

func (c *Client) SetSecurityTokenServicePreferences(ctx context.Context, params *SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesOutput, error)

Sets the specified version of the global endpoint token as the token version used for the AWS account. By default, AWS Security Token Service (STS) is available as a global service, and all STS requests go to a single endpoint at https://sts.amazonaws.com. AWS recommends using Regional STS endpoints to reduce latency, build in redundancy, and increase session token availability. For information about Regional endpoints for STS, see AWS Regions and Endpoints (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/rande.html#sts_region) in the AWS General Reference. If you make an STS call to the global endpoint, the resulting session tokens might be valid in some Regions but not others. It depends on the version that is set in this operation. Version 1 tokens are valid only in AWS Regions that are available by default. These tokens do not work in manually enabled Regions, such as Asia Pacific (Hong Kong). Version 2 tokens are valid in all Regions. However, version 2 tokens are longer and might affect systems where you temporarily store tokens. For information, see Activating and Deactivating STS in an AWS Region (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_temp_enable-regions.html) in the IAM User Guide. To view the current session token version, see the GlobalEndpointTokenVersion entry in the response of the GetAccountSummary operation.

func (*Client) SimulateCustomPolicy

func (c *Client) SimulateCustomPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *SimulateCustomPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*SimulateCustomPolicyOutput, error)

Simulate how a set of IAM policies and optionally a resource-based policy works with a list of API operations and AWS resources to determine the policies' effective permissions. The policies are provided as strings. The simulation does not perform the API operations; it only checks the authorization to determine if the simulated policies allow or deny the operations. If you want to simulate existing policies that are attached to an IAM user, group, or role, use SimulatePrincipalPolicy instead. Context keys are variables that are maintained by AWS and its services and which provide details about the context of an API query request. You can use the Condition element of an IAM policy to evaluate context keys. To get the list of context keys that the policies require for correct simulation, use GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy. If the output is long, you can use MaxItems and Marker parameters to paginate the results.

func (*Client) SimulatePrincipalPolicy

func (c *Client) SimulatePrincipalPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*SimulatePrincipalPolicyOutput, error)

Simulate how a set of IAM policies attached to an IAM entity works with a list of API operations and AWS resources to determine the policies' effective permissions. The entity can be an IAM user, group, or role. If you specify a user, then the simulation also includes all of the policies that are attached to groups that the user belongs to. You can optionally include a list of one or more additional policies specified as strings to include in the simulation. If you want to simulate only policies specified as strings, use SimulateCustomPolicy instead. You can also optionally include one resource-based policy to be evaluated with each of the resources included in the simulation. The simulation does not perform the API operations; it only checks the authorization to determine if the simulated policies allow or deny the operations. Note: This API discloses information about the permissions granted to other users. If you do not want users to see other user's permissions, then consider allowing them to use SimulateCustomPolicy instead. Context keys are variables maintained by AWS and its services that provide details about the context of an API query request. You can use the Condition element of an IAM policy to evaluate context keys. To get the list of context keys that the policies require for correct simulation, use GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy. If the output is long, you can use the MaxItems and Marker parameters to paginate the results.

func (*Client) TagRole

func (c *Client) TagRole(ctx context.Context, params *TagRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*TagRoleOutput, error)

Adds one or more tags to an IAM role. The role can be a regular role or a service-linked role. If a tag with the same key name already exists, then that tag is overwritten with the new value. A tag consists of a key name and an associated value. By assigning tags to your resources, you can do the following:

* Administrative grouping and discovery - Attach tags to resources to aid in organization and search. For example, you could search for all resources with the key name Project and the value MyImportantProject. Or search for all resources with the key name Cost Center and the value 41200.

* Access control - Reference tags in IAM user-based and resource-based policies. You can use tags to restrict access to only an IAM user or role that has a specified tag attached. You can also restrict access to only those resources that have a certain tag attached. For examples of policies that show how to use tags to control access, see Control Access Using IAM Tags (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

* Cost allocation - Use tags to help track which individuals and teams are using which AWS resources.

* Make sure that you have no invalid tags and that you do not exceed the allowed number of tags per role. In either case, the entire request fails and no tags are added to the role.

* AWS always interprets the tag Value as a single string. If you need to store an array, you can store comma-separated values in the string. However, you must interpret the value in your code.

For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) TagUser

func (c *Client) TagUser(ctx context.Context, params *TagUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*TagUserOutput, error)

Adds one or more tags to an IAM user. If a tag with the same key name already exists, then that tag is overwritten with the new value. A tag consists of a key name and an associated value. By assigning tags to your resources, you can do the following:

* Administrative grouping and discovery - Attach tags to resources to aid in organization and search. For example, you could search for all resources with the key name Project and the value MyImportantProject. Or search for all resources with the key name Cost Center and the value 41200.

* Access control - Reference tags in IAM user-based and resource-based policies. You can use tags to restrict access to only an IAM requesting user or to a role that has a specified tag attached. You can also restrict access to only those resources that have a certain tag attached. For examples of policies that show how to use tags to control access, see Control Access Using IAM Tags (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

* Cost allocation - Use tags to help track which individuals and teams are using which AWS resources.

* Make sure that you have no invalid tags and that you do not exceed the allowed number of tags per role. In either case, the entire request fails and no tags are added to the role.

* AWS always interprets the tag Value as a single string. If you need to store an array, you can store comma-separated values in the string. However, you must interpret the value in your code.

For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UntagRole

func (c *Client) UntagRole(ctx context.Context, params *UntagRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UntagRoleOutput, error)

Removes the specified tags from the role. For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UntagUser

func (c *Client) UntagUser(ctx context.Context, params *UntagUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UntagUserOutput, error)

Removes the specified tags from the user. For more information about tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateAccessKey

func (c *Client) UpdateAccessKey(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateAccessKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateAccessKeyOutput, error)

Changes the status of the specified access key from Active to Inactive, or vice versa. This operation can be used to disable a user's key as part of a key rotation workflow. If the UserName is not specified, the user name is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. For information about rotating keys, see Managing Keys and Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/ManagingCredentials.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy

func (c *Client) UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput, error)

Updates the password policy settings for the AWS account.

* This operation does not support partial updates. No parameters are required, but if you do not specify a parameter, that parameter's value reverts to its default value. See the Request Parameters section for each parameter's default value. Also note that some parameters do not allow the default parameter to be explicitly set. Instead, to invoke the default value, do not include that parameter when you invoke the operation.

For more information about using a password policy, see Managing an IAM Password Policy (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingPasswordPolicies.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateAssumeRolePolicy

func (c *Client) UpdateAssumeRolePolicy(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput, error)

Updates the policy that grants an IAM entity permission to assume a role. This is typically referred to as the "role trust policy". For more information about roles, go to Using Roles to Delegate Permissions and Federate Identities (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/roles-toplevel.html).

func (*Client) UpdateGroup

func (c *Client) UpdateGroup(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateGroupInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateGroupOutput, error)

Updates the name and/or the path of the specified IAM group. You should understand the implications of changing a group's path or name. For more information, see Renaming Users and Groups (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_WorkingWithGroupsAndUsers.html) in the IAM User Guide. The person making the request (the principal), must have permission to change the role group with the old name and the new name. For example, to change the group named Managers to MGRs, the principal must have a policy that allows them to update both groups. If the principal has permission to update the Managers group, but not the MGRs group, then the update fails. For more information about permissions, see Access Management (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access.html).

func (*Client) UpdateLoginProfile

func (c *Client) UpdateLoginProfile(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateLoginProfileInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateLoginProfileOutput, error)

Changes the password for the specified IAM user. IAM users can change their own passwords by calling ChangePassword. For more information about modifying passwords, see Managing Passwords (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_ManagingLogins.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint

func (c *Client) UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput, error)

Replaces the existing list of server certificate thumbprints associated with an OpenID Connect (OIDC) provider resource object with a new list of thumbprints. The list that you pass with this operation completely replaces the existing list of thumbprints. (The lists are not merged.) Typically, you need to update a thumbprint only when the identity provider's certificate changes, which occurs rarely. However, if the provider's certificate does change, any attempt to assume an IAM role that specifies the OIDC provider as a principal fails until the certificate thumbprint is updated. Trust for the OIDC provider is derived from the provider's certificate and is validated by the thumbprint. Therefore, it is best to limit access to the UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprint operation to highly privileged users.

func (*Client) UpdateRole

func (c *Client) UpdateRole(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateRoleInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateRoleOutput, error)

Updates the description or maximum session duration setting of a role.

func (*Client) UpdateRoleDescription

func (c *Client) UpdateRoleDescription(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateRoleDescriptionInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput, error)

Use UpdateRole instead. Modifies only the description of a role. This operation performs the same function as the Description parameter in the UpdateRole operation.

func (*Client) UpdateSAMLProvider

func (c *Client) UpdateSAMLProvider(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateSAMLProviderInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateSAMLProviderOutput, error)

Updates the metadata document for an existing SAML provider resource object. This operation requires Signature Version 4 (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).

func (*Client) UpdateSSHPublicKey

func (c *Client) UpdateSSHPublicKey(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput, error)

Sets the status of an IAM user's SSH public key to active or inactive. SSH public keys that are inactive cannot be used for authentication. This operation can be used to disable a user's SSH public key as part of a key rotation work flow. The SSH public key affected by this operation is used only for authenticating the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateServerCertificate

func (c *Client) UpdateServerCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateServerCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateServerCertificateOutput, error)

Updates the name and/or the path of the specified server certificate stored in IAM. For more information about working with server certificates, see Working with Server Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) in the IAM User Guide. This topic also includes a list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage with IAM. You should understand the implications of changing a server certificate's path or name. For more information, see Renaming a Server Certificate (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs_manage.html#RenamingServerCerts) in the IAM User Guide. The person making the request (the principal), must have permission to change the server certificate with the old name and the new name. For example, to change the certificate named ProductionCert to ProdCert, the principal must have a policy that allows them to update both certificates. If the principal has permission to update the ProductionCert group, but not the ProdCert certificate, then the update fails. For more information about permissions, see Access Management (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UpdateServiceSpecificCredential

func (c *Client) UpdateServiceSpecificCredential(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput, error)

Sets the status of a service-specific credential to Active or Inactive. Service-specific credentials that are inactive cannot be used for authentication to the service. This operation can be used to disable a user's service-specific credential as part of a credential rotation work flow.

func (*Client) UpdateSigningCertificate

func (c *Client) UpdateSigningCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateSigningCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateSigningCertificateOutput, error)

Changes the status of the specified user signing certificate from active to disabled, or vice versa. This operation can be used to disable an IAM user's signing certificate as part of a certificate rotation work flow. If the UserName field is not specified, the user name is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users.

func (*Client) UpdateUser

func (c *Client) UpdateUser(ctx context.Context, params *UpdateUserInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UpdateUserOutput, error)

Updates the name and/or the path of the specified IAM user. You should understand the implications of changing an IAM user's path or name. For more information, see Renaming an IAM User (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_users_manage.html#id_users_renaming) and Renaming an IAM Group (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_groups_manage_rename.html) in the IAM User Guide. To change a user name, the requester must have appropriate permissions on both the source object and the target object. For example, to change Bob to Robert, the entity making the request must have permission on Bob and Robert, or must have permission on all (*). For more information about permissions, see Permissions and Policies (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/PermissionsAndPolicies.html).

func (*Client) UploadSSHPublicKey

func (c *Client) UploadSSHPublicKey(ctx context.Context, params *UploadSSHPublicKeyInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput, error)

Uploads an SSH public key and associates it with the specified IAM user. The SSH public key uploaded by this operation can be used only for authenticating the associated IAM user to an AWS CodeCommit repository. For more information about using SSH keys to authenticate to an AWS CodeCommit repository, see Set up AWS CodeCommit for SSH Connections (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/codecommit/latest/userguide/setting-up-credentials-ssh.html) in the AWS CodeCommit User Guide.

func (*Client) UploadServerCertificate

func (c *Client) UploadServerCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *UploadServerCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UploadServerCertificateOutput, error)

Uploads a server certificate entity for the AWS account. The server certificate entity includes a public key certificate, a private key, and an optional certificate chain, which should all be PEM-encoded. We recommend that you use AWS Certificate Manager (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/acm/) to provision, manage, and deploy your server certificates. With ACM you can request a certificate, deploy it to AWS resources, and let ACM handle certificate renewals for you. Certificates provided by ACM are free. For more information about using ACM, see the AWS Certificate Manager User Guide (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/acm/latest/userguide/). For more information about working with server certificates, see Working with Server Certificates (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_server-certs.html) in the IAM User Guide. This topic includes a list of AWS services that can use the server certificates that you manage with IAM. For information about the number of server certificates you can upload, see Limitations on IAM Entities and Objects (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_iam-limits.html) in the IAM User Guide. Because the body of the public key certificate, private key, and the certificate chain can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling UploadServerCertificate. For information about setting up signatures and authorization through the API, go to Signing AWS API Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signing_aws_api_requests.html) in the AWS General Reference. For general information about using the Query API with IAM, go to Calling the API by Making HTTP Query Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/programming.html) in the IAM User Guide.

func (*Client) UploadSigningCertificate

func (c *Client) UploadSigningCertificate(ctx context.Context, params *UploadSigningCertificateInput, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*UploadSigningCertificateOutput, error)

Uploads an X.509 signing certificate and associates it with the specified IAM user. Some AWS services use X.509 signing certificates to validate requests that are signed with a corresponding private key. When you upload the certificate, its default status is Active. If the UserName is not specified, the IAM user name is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key ID used to sign the request. This operation works for access keys under the AWS account. Consequently, you can use this operation to manage AWS account root user credentials even if the AWS account has no associated users. Because the body of an X.509 certificate can be large, you should use POST rather than GET when calling UploadSigningCertificate. For information about setting up signatures and authorization through the API, go to Signing AWS API Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signing_aws_api_requests.html) in the AWS General Reference. For general information about using the Query API with IAM, go to Making Query Requests (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/IAM_UsingQueryAPI.html) in the IAM User Guide.

type CreateAccessKeyInput

type CreateAccessKeyInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM user that the new key will belong to. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type CreateAccessKeyOutput

type CreateAccessKeyOutput struct {

	// A structure with details about the access key.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccessKey *types.AccessKey

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateAccessKey request.

type CreateAccountAliasInput

type CreateAccountAliasInput struct {

	// The account alias to create. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// lowercase letters, digits, and dashes. You cannot start or finish with a dash,
	// nor can you have two dashes in a row.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccountAlias *string
}

type CreateAccountAliasOutput

type CreateAccountAliasOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type CreateGroupInput

type CreateGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the group to create. Do not include the path in this value. IAM
	// user, group, role, and policy names must be unique within the account. Names are
	// not distinguished by case. For example, you cannot create resources named both
	// "MyResource" and "myresource".
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The path to the group. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string
}

type CreateGroupOutput

type CreateGroupOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new group.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Group *types.Group

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateGroup request.

type CreateInstanceProfileInput

type CreateInstanceProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the instance profile to create. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfileName *string

	// The path to the instance profile. For more information about paths, see IAM
	// Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string
}

type CreateInstanceProfileOutput

type CreateInstanceProfileOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new instance profile.
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfile *types.InstanceProfile

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateInstanceProfile request.

type CreateLoginProfileInput

type CreateLoginProfileInput struct {

	// The new password for the user. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) that is used to validate this parameter is a
	// string of characters. That string can include almost any printable ASCII
	// character from the space (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character range
	// (\u00FF). You can also include the tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and
	// carriage return (\u000D) characters. Any of these characters are valid in a
	// password. However, many tools, such as the AWS Management Console, might
	// restrict the ability to type certain characters because they have special
	// meaning within that tool.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Password *string

	// The name of the IAM user to create a password for. The user must already exist.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Specifies whether the user is required to set a new password on next sign-in.
	PasswordResetRequired bool
}

type CreateLoginProfileOutput

type CreateLoginProfileOutput struct {

	// A structure containing the user name and password create date.
	//
	// This member is required.
	LoginProfile *types.LoginProfile

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateLoginProfile request.

type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput

type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct {

	// A list of server certificate thumbprints for the OpenID Connect (OIDC) identity
	// provider's server certificates. Typically this list includes only one entry.
	// However, IAM lets you have up to five thumbprints for an OIDC provider. This
	// lets you maintain multiple thumbprints if the identity provider is rotating
	// certificates. The server certificate thumbprint is the hex-encoded SHA-1 hash
	// value of the X.509 certificate used by the domain where the OpenID Connect
	// provider makes its keys available. It is always a 40-character string. You must
	// provide at least one thumbprint when creating an IAM OIDC provider. For example,
	// assume that the OIDC provider is server.example.com and the provider stores its
	// keys at https://keys.server.example.com/openid-connect. In that case, the
	// thumbprint string would be the hex-encoded SHA-1 hash value of the certificate
	// used by https://keys.server.example.com. For more information about obtaining
	// the OIDC provider's thumbprint, see Obtaining the Thumbprint for an OpenID
	// Connect Provider
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/identity-providers-oidc-obtain-thumbprint.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ThumbprintList []string

	// The URL of the identity provider. The URL must begin with https:// and should
	// correspond to the iss claim in the provider's OpenID Connect ID tokens. Per the
	// OIDC standard, path components are allowed but query parameters are not.
	// Typically the URL consists of only a hostname, like https://server.example.org
	// or https://example.com. You cannot register the same provider multiple times in
	// a single AWS account. If you try to submit a URL that has already been used for
	// an OpenID Connect provider in the AWS account, you will get an error.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Url *string

	// A list of client IDs (also known as audiences). When a mobile or web app
	// registers with an OpenID Connect provider, they establish a value that
	// identifies the application. (This is the value that's sent as the client_id
	// parameter on OAuth requests.) You can register multiple client IDs with the same
	// provider. For example, you might have multiple applications that use the same
	// OIDC provider. You cannot register more than 100 client IDs with a single IAM
	// OIDC provider. There is no defined format for a client ID. The
	// CreateOpenIDConnectProviderRequest operation accepts client IDs up to 255
	// characters long.
	ClientIDList []string
}

type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput

type CreateOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the new IAM OpenID Connect provider that is
	// created. For more information, see OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateOpenIDConnectProvider request.

type CreatePolicyInput

type CreatePolicyInput struct {

	// The JSON policy document that you want to use as the content for the new policy.
	// You must provide policies in JSON format in IAM. However, for AWS CloudFormation
	// templates formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy in JSON or YAML format.
	// AWS CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON format before
	// submitting it to IAM. The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used
	// to validate this parameter is a string of characters consisting of the
	// following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging from the space character
	// (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character range
	//
	// * The printable
	// characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement character set (through
	// \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage
	// return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The friendly name of the policy. IAM user, group, role, and policy names must be
	// unique within the account. Names are not distinguished by case. For example, you
	// cannot create resources named both "MyResource" and "myresource".
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// A friendly description of the policy. Typically used to store information about
	// the permissions defined in the policy. For example, "Grants access to production
	// DynamoDB tables." The policy description is immutable. After a value is
	// assigned, it cannot be changed.
	Description *string

	// The path for the policy. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string
}

type CreatePolicyOutput

type CreatePolicyOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new policy.
	Policy *types.Policy

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreatePolicy request.

type CreatePolicyVersionInput

type CreatePolicyVersionInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy to which you want to add a new
	// version. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and
	// AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The JSON policy document that you want to use as the content for this new
	// version of the policy. You must provide policies in JSON format in IAM. However,
	// for AWS CloudFormation templates formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy
	// in JSON or YAML format. AWS CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON
	// format before submitting it to IAM. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// Specifies whether to set this version as the policy's default version. When this
	// parameter is true, the new policy version becomes the operative version. That
	// is, it becomes the version that is in effect for the IAM users, groups, and
	// roles that the policy is attached to. For more information about managed policy
	// versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	SetAsDefault bool
}

type CreatePolicyVersionOutput

type CreatePolicyVersionOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new policy version.
	PolicyVersion *types.PolicyVersion

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreatePolicyVersion request.

type CreateRoleInput

type CreateRoleInput struct {

	// The trust relationship policy document that grants an entity permission to
	// assume the role. In IAM, you must provide a JSON policy that has been converted
	// to a string. However, for AWS CloudFormation templates formatted in YAML, you
	// can provide the policy in JSON or YAML format. AWS CloudFormation always
	// converts a YAML policy to JSON format before submitting it to IAM. The regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a
	// string of characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII
	// character ranging from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII
	// character range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1
	// Supplement character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab
	// (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// Upon success, the
	// response includes the same trust policy in JSON format.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AssumeRolePolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the role to create. IAM user, group, role, and policy names must be
	// unique within the account. Names are not distinguished by case. For example, you
	// cannot create resources named both "MyResource" and "myresource".
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// A description of the role.
	Description *string

	// The maximum session duration (in seconds) that you want to set for the specified
	// role. If you do not specify a value for this setting, the default maximum of one
	// hour is applied. This setting can have a value from 1 hour to 12 hours. Anyone
	// who assumes the role from the AWS CLI or API can use the DurationSeconds API
	// parameter or the duration-seconds CLI parameter to request a longer session. The
	// MaxSessionDuration setting determines the maximum duration that can be requested
	// using the DurationSeconds parameter. If users don't specify a value for the
	// DurationSeconds parameter, their security credentials are valid for one hour by
	// default. This applies when you use the AssumeRole* API operations or the
	// assume-role* CLI operations but does not apply when you use those operations to
	// create a console URL. For more information, see Using IAM Roles
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_use.html) in the IAM
	// User Guide.
	MaxSessionDuration *int32

	// The path to the role. For more information about paths, see IAM Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string

	// The ARN of the policy that is used to set the permissions boundary for the role.
	PermissionsBoundary *string

	// A list of tags that you want to attach to the newly created role. Each tag
	// consists of a key name and an associated value. For more information about
	// tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User
	// Guide. If any one of the tags is invalid or if you exceed the allowed number of
	// tags per role, then the entire request fails and the role is not created.
	Tags []types.Tag
}

type CreateRoleOutput

type CreateRoleOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new role.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Role *types.Role

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateRole request.

type CreateSAMLProviderInput

type CreateSAMLProviderInput struct {

	// The name of the provider to create. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	Name *string

	// An XML document generated by an identity provider (IdP) that supports SAML 2.0.
	// The document includes the issuer's name, expiration information, and keys that
	// can be used to validate the SAML authentication response (assertions) that are
	// received from the IdP. You must generate the metadata document using the
	// identity management software that is used as your organization's IdP. For more
	// information, see About SAML 2.0-based Federation
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_providers_saml.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide
	//
	// This member is required.
	SAMLMetadataDocument *string
}

type CreateSAMLProviderOutput

type CreateSAMLProviderOutput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the new SAML provider resource in IAM.
	SAMLProviderArn *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateSAMLProvider request.

type CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput

type CreateServiceLinkedRoleInput struct {

	// The service principal for the AWS service to which this role is attached. You
	// use a string similar to a URL but without the http:// in front. For example:
	// elasticbeanstalk.amazonaws.com. Service principals are unique and
	// case-sensitive. To find the exact service principal for your service-linked
	// role, see AWS Services That Work with IAM
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_aws-services-that-work-with-iam.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide. Look for the services that have Yes in the Service-Linked
	// Role column. Choose the Yes link to view the service-linked role documentation
	// for that service.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AWSServiceName *string

	// A string that you provide, which is combined with the service-provided prefix to
	// form the complete role name. If you make multiple requests for the same service,
	// then you must supply a different CustomSuffix for each request. Otherwise the
	// request fails with a duplicate role name error. For example, you could add -1 or
	// -debug to the suffix. Some services do not support the CustomSuffix parameter.
	// If you provide an optional suffix and the operation fails, try the operation
	// again without the suffix.
	CustomSuffix *string

	// The description of the role.
	Description *string
}

type CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput

type CreateServiceLinkedRoleOutput struct {

	// A Role object that contains details about the newly created role.
	Role *types.Role

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput

type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct {

	// The name of the AWS service that is to be associated with the credentials. The
	// service you specify here is the only service that can be accessed using these
	// credentials.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceName *string

	// The name of the IAM user that is to be associated with the credentials. The new
	// service-specific credentials have the same permissions as the associated user
	// except that they can be used only to access the specified service. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput

type CreateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct {

	// A structure that contains information about the newly created service-specific
	// credential. This is the only time that the password for this credential set is
	// available. It cannot be recovered later. Instead, you must reset the password
	// with ResetServiceSpecificCredential.
	ServiceSpecificCredential *types.ServiceSpecificCredential

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type CreateUserInput

type CreateUserInput struct {

	// The name of the user to create. IAM user, group, role, and policy names must be
	// unique within the account. Names are not distinguished by case. For example, you
	// cannot create resources named both "MyResource" and "myresource".
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// The path for the user name. For more information about paths, see IAM
	// Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string

	// The ARN of the policy that is used to set the permissions boundary for the user.
	PermissionsBoundary *string

	// A list of tags that you want to attach to the newly created user. Each tag
	// consists of a key name and an associated value. For more information about
	// tagging, see Tagging IAM Identities
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_tags.html) in the IAM User
	// Guide. If any one of the tags is invalid or if you exceed the allowed number of
	// tags per user, then the entire request fails and the user is not created.
	Tags []types.Tag
}

type CreateUserOutput

type CreateUserOutput struct {

	// A structure with details about the new IAM user.
	User *types.User

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateUser request.

type CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput

type CreateVirtualMFADeviceInput struct {

	// The name of the virtual MFA device. Use with path to uniquely identify a virtual
	// MFA device. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	VirtualMFADeviceName *string

	// The path for the virtual MFA device. For more information about paths, see IAM
	// Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	Path *string
}

type CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput

type CreateVirtualMFADeviceOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the new virtual MFA device.
	//
	// This member is required.
	VirtualMFADevice *types.VirtualMFADevice

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful CreateVirtualMFADevice request.

type DeactivateMFADeviceInput

type DeactivateMFADeviceInput struct {

	// The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA
	// devices, the serial number is the device ARN. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/-
	//
	// This member is required.
	SerialNumber *string

	// The name of the user whose MFA device you want to deactivate. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeactivateMFADeviceOutput

type DeactivateMFADeviceOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteAccessKeyInput

type DeleteAccessKeyInput struct {

	// The access key ID for the access key ID and secret access key you want to
	// delete. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can consist of
	// any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccessKeyId *string

	// The name of the user whose access key pair you want to delete. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteAccessKeyOutput

type DeleteAccessKeyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteAccountAliasInput

type DeleteAccountAliasInput struct {

	// The name of the account alias to delete. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of lowercase letters, digits, and dashes. You cannot start or finish
	// with a dash, nor can you have two dashes in a row.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccountAlias *string
}

type DeleteAccountAliasOutput

type DeleteAccountAliasOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput

type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct {
}

type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput

type DeleteAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteGroupInput

type DeleteGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM group to delete. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string
}

type DeleteGroupOutput

type DeleteGroupOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteGroupPolicyInput

type DeleteGroupPolicyInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the group that the policy is
	// embedded in. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The name identifying the policy document to delete. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string
}

type DeleteGroupPolicyOutput

type DeleteGroupPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteInstanceProfileInput

type DeleteInstanceProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the instance profile to delete. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfileName *string
}

type DeleteInstanceProfileOutput

type DeleteInstanceProfileOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteLoginProfileInput

type DeleteLoginProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the user whose password you want to delete. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteLoginProfileOutput

type DeleteLoginProfileOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput

type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OpenID Connect provider resource
	// object to delete. You can get a list of OpenID Connect provider resource ARNs by
	// using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string
}

type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput

type DeleteOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeletePolicyInput

type DeletePolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to delete. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string
}

type DeletePolicyOutput

type DeletePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeletePolicyVersionInput

type DeletePolicyVersionInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy from which you want to delete a
	// version. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and
	// AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The policy version to delete. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that consists of the
	// lowercase letter 'v' followed by one or two digits, and optionally followed by a
	// period '.' and a string of letters and digits. For more information about
	// managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	//
	// This member is required.
	VersionId *string
}

type DeletePolicyVersionOutput

type DeletePolicyVersionOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteRoleInput

type DeleteRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the role to delete. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type DeleteRoleOutput

type DeleteRoleOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryInput

type DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM role from which you want to remove
	// the permissions boundary.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput

type DeleteRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteRolePolicyInput

type DeleteRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The name of the inline policy to delete from the specified IAM role. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the role that the policy is
	// embedded in. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type DeleteRolePolicyOutput

type DeleteRolePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteSAMLProviderInput

type DeleteSAMLProviderInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider to delete.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SAMLProviderArn *string
}

type DeleteSAMLProviderOutput

type DeleteSAMLProviderOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput

type DeleteSSHPublicKeyInput struct {

	// The unique identifier for the SSH public key. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can
	// consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SSHPublicKeyId *string

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput

type DeleteSSHPublicKeyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteServerCertificateInput

type DeleteServerCertificateInput struct {

	// The name of the server certificate you want to delete. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificateName *string
}

type DeleteServerCertificateOutput

type DeleteServerCertificateOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput

type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the service-linked role to be deleted.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput

type DeleteServiceLinkedRoleOutput struct {

	// The deletion task identifier that you can use to check the status of the
	// deletion. This identifier is returned in the format task/aws-service-role///.
	//
	// This member is required.
	DeletionTaskId *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput

type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct {

	// The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. You can get this value
	// by calling ListServiceSpecificCredentials. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can
	// consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. If
	// this value is not specified, then the operation assumes the user whose
	// credentials are used to call the operation. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput

type DeleteServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteSigningCertificateInput

type DeleteSigningCertificateInput struct {

	// The ID of the signing certificate to delete. The format of this parameter, as
	// described by its regex (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) pattern, is a string of
	// characters that can be upper- or lower-cased letters or digits.
	//
	// This member is required.
	CertificateId *string

	// The name of the user the signing certificate belongs to. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteSigningCertificateOutput

type DeleteSigningCertificateOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteUserInput

type DeleteUserInput struct {

	// The name of the user to delete. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteUserOutput

type DeleteUserOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryInput

type DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user from which you want to remove
	// the permissions boundary.
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput

type DeleteUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteUserPolicyInput

type DeleteUserPolicyInput struct {

	// The name identifying the policy document to delete. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) identifying the user that the policy is
	// embedded in. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DeleteUserPolicyOutput

type DeleteUserPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput

type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceInput struct {

	// The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA
	// devices, the serial number is the same as the ARN. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/-
	//
	// This member is required.
	SerialNumber *string
}

type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput

type DeleteVirtualMFADeviceOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DetachGroupPolicyInput

type DetachGroupPolicyInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM group to detach the policy from.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string
}

type DetachGroupPolicyOutput

type DetachGroupPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DetachRolePolicyInput

type DetachRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM role to detach the policy from.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type DetachRolePolicyOutput

type DetachRolePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type DetachUserPolicyInput

type DetachUserPolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy you want to detach. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user to detach the policy from.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type DetachUserPolicyOutput

type DetachUserPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type EnableMFADeviceInput

type EnableMFADeviceInput struct {

	// An authentication code emitted by the device. The format for this parameter is a
	// string of six digits. Submit your request immediately after generating the
	// authentication codes. If you generate the codes and then wait too long to submit
	// the request, the MFA device successfully associates with the user but the MFA
	// device becomes out of sync. This happens because time-based one-time passwords
	// (TOTP) expire after a short period of time. If this happens, you can resync the
	// device
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_mfa_sync.html).
	//
	// This member is required.
	AuthenticationCode1 *string

	// A subsequent authentication code emitted by the device. The format for this
	// parameter is a string of six digits. Submit your request immediately after
	// generating the authentication codes. If you generate the codes and then wait too
	// long to submit the request, the MFA device successfully associates with the user
	// but the MFA device becomes out of sync. This happens because time-based one-time
	// passwords (TOTP) expire after a short period of time. If this happens, you can
	// resync the device
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_mfa_sync.html).
	//
	// This member is required.
	AuthenticationCode2 *string

	// The serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. For virtual MFA
	// devices, the serial number is the device ARN. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: =,.@:/-
	//
	// This member is required.
	SerialNumber *string

	// The name of the IAM user for whom you want to enable the MFA device. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type EnableMFADeviceOutput

type EnableMFADeviceOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type EndpointResolver

type EndpointResolver interface {
	ResolveEndpoint(region string, options EndpointResolverOptions) (aws.Endpoint, error)
}

EndpointResolver interface for resolving service endpoints.

type EndpointResolverFunc

type EndpointResolverFunc func(region string, options EndpointResolverOptions) (aws.Endpoint, error)

EndpointResolverFunc is a helper utility that wraps a function so it satisfies the EndpointResolver interface. This is useful when you want to add additional endpoint resolving logic, or stub out specific endpoints with custom values.

func (EndpointResolverFunc) ResolveEndpoint

func (fn EndpointResolverFunc) ResolveEndpoint(region string, options EndpointResolverOptions) (endpoint aws.Endpoint, err error)

type EndpointResolverOptions added in v0.29.0

type EndpointResolverOptions = internalendpoints.Options

EndpointResolverOptions is the service endpoint resolver options

type GenerateCredentialReportInput

type GenerateCredentialReportInput struct {
}

type GenerateCredentialReportOutput

type GenerateCredentialReportOutput struct {

	// Information about the credential report.
	Description *string

	// Information about the state of the credential report.
	State types.ReportStateType

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GenerateCredentialReport request.

type GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportInput

type GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportInput struct {

	// The path of the AWS Organizations entity (root, OU, or account). You can build
	// an entity path using the known structure of your organization. For example,
	// assume that your account ID is 123456789012 and its parent OU ID is
	// ou-rge0-awsabcde. The organization root ID is r-f6g7h8i9j0example and your
	// organization ID is o-a1b2c3d4e5. Your entity path is
	// o-a1b2c3d4e5/r-f6g7h8i9j0example/ou-rge0-awsabcde/123456789012.
	//
	// This member is required.
	EntityPath *string

	// The identifier of the AWS Organizations service control policy (SCP). This
	// parameter is optional. This ID is used to generate information about when an
	// account principal that is limited by the SCP attempted to access an AWS service.
	OrganizationsPolicyId *string
}

type GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportOutput

type GenerateOrganizationsAccessReportOutput struct {

	// The job identifier that you can use in the GetOrganizationsAccessReport
	// operation.
	JobId *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput

type GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput struct {

	// The ARN of the IAM resource (user, group, role, or managed policy) used to
	// generate information about when the resource was last used in an attempt to
	// access an AWS service.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Arn *string

	// The level of detail that you want to generate. You can specify whether you want
	// to generate information about the last attempt to access services or actions. If
	// you specify service-level granularity, this operation generates only service
	// data. If you specify action-level granularity, it generates service and action
	// data. If you don't include this optional parameter, the operation generates
	// service data.
	Granularity types.AccessAdvisorUsageGranularityType
}

type GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput

type GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput struct {

	// The JobId that you can use in the GetServiceLastAccessedDetails or
	// GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities operations. The JobId returned by
	// GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetail must be used by the same role within a
	// session, or by the same user when used to call GetServiceLastAccessedDetail.
	JobId *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput

type GetAccessKeyLastUsedInput struct {

	// The identifier of an access key. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can
	// consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccessKeyId *string
}

type GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput

type GetAccessKeyLastUsedOutput struct {

	// Contains information about the last time the access key was used.
	AccessKeyLastUsed *types.AccessKeyLastUsed

	// The name of the AWS IAM user that owns this access key.
	UserName *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetAccessKeyLastUsed request. It is also returned as a member of the AccessKeyMetaData structure returned by the ListAccessKeys action.

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsAPIClient interface {
	GetAccountAuthorizationDetails(context.Context, *GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput, ...func(*Options)) (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput, error)
}

GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsAPIClient is a client that implements the GetAccountAuthorizationDetails operation.

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsInput struct {

	// A list of entity types used to filter the results. Only the entities that match
	// the types you specify are included in the output. Use the value
	// LocalManagedPolicy to include customer managed policies. The format for this
	// parameter is a comma-separated (if more than one) list of strings. Each string
	// value in the list must be one of the valid values listed below.
	Filter []types.EntityType

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsOutput struct {

	// A list containing information about IAM groups.
	GroupDetailList []types.GroupDetail

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// A list containing information about managed policies.
	Policies []types.ManagedPolicyDetail

	// A list containing information about IAM roles.
	RoleDetailList []types.RoleDetail

	// A list containing information about IAM users.
	UserDetailList []types.UserDetail

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetAccountAuthorizationDetails request.

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator added in v0.30.0

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator is a paginator for GetAccountAuthorizationDetails

func NewGetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewGetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator returns a new GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator

func (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next GetAccountAuthorizationDetails page.

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

GetAccountAuthorizationDetailsPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for GetAccountAuthorizationDetails

type GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput

type GetAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct {
}

type GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput

type GetAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct {

	// A structure that contains details about the account's password policy.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PasswordPolicy *types.PasswordPolicy

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetAccountPasswordPolicy request.

type GetAccountSummaryInput

type GetAccountSummaryInput struct {
}

type GetAccountSummaryOutput

type GetAccountSummaryOutput struct {

	// A set of key–value pairs containing information about IAM entity usage and IAM
	// quotas.
	SummaryMap map[string]int32

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetAccountSummary request.

type GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput

type GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyInput struct {

	// A list of policies for which you want the list of context keys referenced in
	// those policies. Each document is specified as a string containing the complete,
	// valid JSON text of an IAM policy. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyInputList []string
}

type GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyOutput

type GetContextKeysForCustomPolicyOutput struct {

	// The list of context keys that are referenced in the input policies.
	ContextKeyNames []string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy or GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy request.

type GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput

type GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyInput struct {

	// The ARN of a user, group, or role whose policies contain the context keys that
	// you want listed. If you specify a user, the list includes context keys that are
	// found in all policies that are attached to the user. The list also includes all
	// groups that the user is a member of. If you pick a group or a role, then it
	// includes only those context keys that are found in policies attached to that
	// entity. Note that all parameters are shown in unencoded form here for clarity,
	// but must be URL encoded to be included as a part of a real HTML request. For
	// more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicySourceArn *string

	// An optional list of additional policies for which you want the list of context
	// keys that are referenced. The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)
	// used to validate this parameter is a string of characters consisting of the
	// following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging from the space character
	// (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character range
	//
	// * The printable
	// characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement character set (through
	// \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage
	// return (\u000D)
	PolicyInputList []string
}

type GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyOutput

type GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicyOutput struct {

	// The list of context keys that are referenced in the input policies.
	ContextKeyNames []string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetContextKeysForPrincipalPolicy or GetContextKeysForCustomPolicy request.

type GetCredentialReportInput

type GetCredentialReportInput struct {
}

type GetCredentialReportOutput

type GetCredentialReportOutput struct {

	// Contains the credential report. The report is Base64-encoded.
	Content []byte

	// The date and time when the credential report was created, in ISO 8601 date-time
	// format (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601).
	GeneratedTime *time.Time

	// The format (MIME type) of the credential report.
	ReportFormat types.ReportFormatType

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetCredentialReport request.

type GetGroupAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type GetGroupAPIClient interface {
	GetGroup(context.Context, *GetGroupInput, ...func(*Options)) (*GetGroupOutput, error)
}

GetGroupAPIClient is a client that implements the GetGroup operation.

type GetGroupInput

type GetGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the group. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type GetGroupOutput

type GetGroupOutput struct {

	// A structure that contains details about the group.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Group *types.Group

	// A list of users in the group.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Users []types.User

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetGroup request.

type GetGroupPaginator added in v0.30.0

type GetGroupPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GetGroupPaginator is a paginator for GetGroup

func NewGetGroupPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewGetGroupPaginator(client GetGroupAPIClient, params *GetGroupInput, optFns ...func(*GetGroupPaginatorOptions)) *GetGroupPaginator

NewGetGroupPaginator returns a new GetGroupPaginator

func (*GetGroupPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *GetGroupPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*GetGroupPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *GetGroupPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*GetGroupOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next GetGroup page.

type GetGroupPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type GetGroupPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

GetGroupPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for GetGroup

type GetGroupPolicyInput

type GetGroupPolicyInput struct {

	// The name of the group the policy is associated with. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The name of the policy document to get. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string
}

type GetGroupPolicyOutput

type GetGroupPolicyOutput struct {

	// The group the policy is associated with.
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The policy document. IAM stores policies in JSON format. However, resources that
	// were created using AWS CloudFormation templates can be formatted in YAML. AWS
	// CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON format before submitting it
	// to IAM.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetGroupPolicy request.

type GetInstanceProfileAPIClient added in v0.31.0

type GetInstanceProfileAPIClient interface {
	GetInstanceProfile(context.Context, *GetInstanceProfileInput, ...func(*Options)) (*GetInstanceProfileOutput, error)
}

GetInstanceProfileAPIClient is a client that implements the GetInstanceProfile operation.

type GetInstanceProfileInput

type GetInstanceProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the instance profile to get information about. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfileName *string
}

type GetInstanceProfileOutput

type GetInstanceProfileOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the instance profile.
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfile *types.InstanceProfile

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetInstanceProfile request.

type GetLoginProfileInput

type GetLoginProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the user whose login profile you want to retrieve. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type GetLoginProfileOutput

type GetLoginProfileOutput struct {

	// A structure containing the user name and password create date for the user.
	//
	// This member is required.
	LoginProfile *types.LoginProfile

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetLoginProfile request.

type GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput

type GetOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the OIDC provider resource object in IAM to
	// get information for. You can get a list of OIDC provider resource ARNs by using
	// the ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation. For more information about ARNs, see
	// Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string
}

type GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput

type GetOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct {

	// A list of client IDs (also known as audiences) that are associated with the
	// specified IAM OIDC provider resource object. For more information, see
	// CreateOpenIDConnectProvider.
	ClientIDList []string

	// The date and time when the IAM OIDC provider resource object was created in the
	// AWS account.
	CreateDate *time.Time

	// A list of certificate thumbprints that are associated with the specified IAM
	// OIDC provider resource object. For more information, see
	// CreateOpenIDConnectProvider.
	ThumbprintList []string

	// The URL that the IAM OIDC provider resource object is associated with. For more
	// information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider.
	Url *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetOpenIDConnectProvider request.

type GetOrganizationsAccessReportInput

type GetOrganizationsAccessReportInput struct {

	// The identifier of the request generated by the GenerateOrganizationsAccessReport
	// operation.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobId *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The key that is used to sort the results. If you choose the namespace key, the
	// results are returned in alphabetical order. If you choose the time key, the
	// results are sorted numerically by the date and time.
	SortKey types.SortKeyType
}

type GetOrganizationsAccessReportOutput

type GetOrganizationsAccessReportOutput struct {

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the report job was created.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobCreationDate *time.Time

	// The status of the job.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobStatus types.JobStatusType

	// An object that contains details about the most recent attempt to access the
	// service.
	AccessDetails []types.AccessDetail

	// Contains information about the reason that the operation failed. This data type
	// is used as a response element in the GetOrganizationsAccessReport,
	// GetServiceLastAccessedDetails, and GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntities
	// operations.
	ErrorDetails *types.ErrorDetails

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the generated report job was completed or
	// failed. This field is null if the job is still in progress, as indicated by a
	// job status value of IN_PROGRESS.
	JobCompletionDate *time.Time

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// The number of services that the applicable SCPs allow account principals to
	// access.
	NumberOfServicesAccessible *int32

	// The number of services that account principals are allowed but did not attempt
	// to access.
	NumberOfServicesNotAccessed *int32

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GetPolicyInput

type GetPolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the managed policy that you want information
	// about. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS
	// Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string
}

type GetPolicyOutput

type GetPolicyOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the policy.
	Policy *types.Policy

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetPolicy request.

type GetPolicyVersionInput

type GetPolicyVersionInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the managed policy that you want information
	// about. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS
	// Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// Identifies the policy version to retrieve. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that
	// consists of the lowercase letter 'v' followed by one or two digits, and
	// optionally followed by a period '.' and a string of letters and digits.
	//
	// This member is required.
	VersionId *string
}

type GetPolicyVersionOutput

type GetPolicyVersionOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the policy version.
	PolicyVersion *types.PolicyVersion

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetPolicyVersion request.

type GetRoleInput

type GetRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM role to get information about. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type GetRoleOutput

type GetRoleOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the IAM role.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Role *types.Role

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetRole request.

type GetRolePolicyInput

type GetRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The name of the policy document to get. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name of the role associated with the policy. This parameter allows (through
	// its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type GetRolePolicyOutput

type GetRolePolicyOutput struct {

	// The policy document. IAM stores policies in JSON format. However, resources that
	// were created using AWS CloudFormation templates can be formatted in YAML. AWS
	// CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON format before submitting it
	// to IAM.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The role the policy is associated with.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetRolePolicy request.

type GetSAMLProviderInput

type GetSAMLProviderInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider resource object in IAM to
	// get information about. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource
	// Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SAMLProviderArn *string
}

type GetSAMLProviderOutput

type GetSAMLProviderOutput struct {

	// The date and time when the SAML provider was created.
	CreateDate *time.Time

	// The XML metadata document that includes information about an identity provider.
	SAMLMetadataDocument *string

	// The expiration date and time for the SAML provider.
	ValidUntil *time.Time

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetSAMLProvider request.

type GetSSHPublicKeyInput

type GetSSHPublicKeyInput struct {

	// Specifies the public key encoding format to use in the response. To retrieve the
	// public key in ssh-rsa format, use SSH. To retrieve the public key in PEM format,
	// use PEM.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Encoding types.EncodingType

	// The unique identifier for the SSH public key. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can
	// consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SSHPublicKeyId *string

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type GetSSHPublicKeyOutput

type GetSSHPublicKeyOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the SSH public key.
	SSHPublicKey *types.SSHPublicKey

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetSSHPublicKey request.

type GetServerCertificateInput

type GetServerCertificateInput struct {

	// The name of the server certificate you want to retrieve information about. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificateName *string
}

type GetServerCertificateOutput

type GetServerCertificateOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the server certificate.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificate *types.ServerCertificate

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetServerCertificate request.

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsInput struct {

	// The ID of the request generated by the GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails
	// operation. The JobId returned by GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetail must be used
	// by the same role within a session, or by the same user when used to call
	// GetServiceLastAccessedDetail.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobId *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsOutput struct {

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the generated report job was completed or
	// failed. This field is null if the job is still in progress, as indicated by a
	// job status value of IN_PROGRESS.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobCompletionDate *time.Time

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the report job was created.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobCreationDate *time.Time

	// The status of the job.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobStatus types.JobStatusType

	// A ServiceLastAccessed object that contains details about the most recent attempt
	// to access the service.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServicesLastAccessed []types.ServiceLastAccessed

	// An object that contains details about the reason the operation failed.
	Error *types.ErrorDetails

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// The type of job. Service jobs return information about when each service was
	// last accessed. Action jobs also include information about when tracked actions
	// within the service were last accessed.
	JobType types.AccessAdvisorUsageGranularityType

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesInput

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesInput struct {

	// The ID of the request generated by the GenerateServiceLastAccessedDetails
	// operation.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobId *string

	// The service namespace for an AWS service. Provide the service namespace to learn
	// when the IAM entity last attempted to access the specified service. To learn the
	// service namespace for a service, go to Actions, Resources, and Condition Keys
	// for AWS Services
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_actions-resources-contextkeys.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide. Choose the name of the service to view details for that
	// service. In the first paragraph, find the service prefix. For example, (service
	// prefix: a4b). For more information about service namespaces, see AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html#genref-aws-service-namespaces)
	// in the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceNamespace *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesOutput

type GetServiceLastAccessedDetailsWithEntitiesOutput struct {

	// An EntityDetailsList object that contains details about when an IAM entity (user
	// or role) used group or policy permissions in an attempt to access the specified
	// AWS service.
	//
	// This member is required.
	EntityDetailsList []types.EntityDetails

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the generated report job was completed or
	// failed. This field is null if the job is still in progress, as indicated by a
	// job status value of IN_PROGRESS.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobCompletionDate *time.Time

	// The date and time, in ISO 8601 date-time format
	// (http://www.iso.org/iso/iso8601), when the report job was created.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobCreationDate *time.Time

	// The status of the job.
	//
	// This member is required.
	JobStatus types.JobStatusType

	// An object that contains details about the reason the operation failed.
	Error *types.ErrorDetails

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput

type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusInput struct {

	// The deletion task identifier. This identifier is returned by the
	// DeleteServiceLinkedRole operation in the format task/aws-service-role///.
	//
	// This member is required.
	DeletionTaskId *string
}

type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput

type GetServiceLinkedRoleDeletionStatusOutput struct {

	// The status of the deletion.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Status types.DeletionTaskStatusType

	// An object that contains details about the reason the deletion failed.
	Reason *types.DeletionTaskFailureReasonType

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type GetUserInput

type GetUserInput struct {

	// The name of the user to get information about. This parameter is optional. If it
	// is not included, it defaults to the user making the request. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type GetUserOutput

type GetUserOutput struct {

	// A structure containing details about the IAM user. Due to a service issue,
	// password last used data does not include password use from May 3, 2018 22:50 PDT
	// to May 23, 2018 14:08 PDT. This affects last sign-in
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_finding-unused.html)
	// dates shown in the IAM console and password last used dates in the IAM
	// credential report
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_getting-report.html),
	// and returned by this GetUser API. If users signed in during the affected time,
	// the password last used date that is returned is the date the user last signed in
	// before May 3, 2018. For users that signed in after May 23, 2018 14:08 PDT, the
	// returned password last used date is accurate. You can use password last used
	// information to identify unused credentials for deletion. For example, you might
	// delete users who did not sign in to AWS in the last 90 days. In cases like this,
	// we recommend that you adjust your evaluation window to include dates after May
	// 23, 2018. Alternatively, if your users use access keys to access AWS
	// programmatically you can refer to access key last used information because it is
	// accurate for all dates.
	//
	// This member is required.
	User *types.User

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetUser request.

type GetUserPolicyInput

type GetUserPolicyInput struct {

	// The name of the policy document to get. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name of the user who the policy is associated with. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type GetUserPolicyOutput

type GetUserPolicyOutput struct {

	// The policy document. IAM stores policies in JSON format. However, resources that
	// were created using AWS CloudFormation templates can be formatted in YAML. AWS
	// CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON format before submitting it
	// to IAM.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The user the policy is associated with.
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful GetUserPolicy request.

type HTTPClient

type HTTPClient interface {
	Do(*http.Request) (*http.Response, error)
}

type HTTPSignerV4

type HTTPSignerV4 interface {
	SignHTTP(ctx context.Context, credentials aws.Credentials, r *http.Request, payloadHash string, service string, region string, signingTime time.Time, optFns ...func(*v4.SignerOptions)) error
}

type InstanceProfileExistsWaiter added in v0.31.0

type InstanceProfileExistsWaiter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

InstanceProfileExistsWaiter defines the waiters for InstanceProfileExists

func NewInstanceProfileExistsWaiter added in v0.31.0

func NewInstanceProfileExistsWaiter(client GetInstanceProfileAPIClient, optFns ...func(*InstanceProfileExistsWaiterOptions)) *InstanceProfileExistsWaiter

NewInstanceProfileExistsWaiter constructs a InstanceProfileExistsWaiter.

func (*InstanceProfileExistsWaiter) Wait added in v0.31.0

Wait calls the waiter function for InstanceProfileExists waiter. The maxWaitDur is the maximum wait duration the waiter will wait. The maxWaitDur is required and must be greater than zero.

type InstanceProfileExistsWaiterOptions added in v0.31.0

type InstanceProfileExistsWaiterOptions struct {

	// Set of options to modify how an operation is invoked. These apply to all
	// operations invoked for this client. Use functional options on operation call to
	// modify this list for per operation behavior.
	APIOptions []func(*middleware.Stack) error

	// MinDelay is the minimum amount of time to delay between retries. If unset,
	// InstanceProfileExistsWaiter will use default minimum delay of 1 seconds. Note
	// that MinDelay must resolve to a value lesser than or equal to the MaxDelay.
	MinDelay time.Duration

	// MaxDelay is the maximum amount of time to delay between retries. If unset or set
	// to zero, InstanceProfileExistsWaiter will use default max delay of 120 seconds.
	// Note that MaxDelay must resolve to value greater than or equal to the MinDelay.
	MaxDelay time.Duration

	// LogWaitAttempts is used to enable logging for waiter retry attempts
	LogWaitAttempts bool

	// Retryable is function that can be used to override the service defined
	// waiter-behavior based on operation output, or returned error. This function is
	// used by the waiter to decide if a state is retryable or a terminal state. By
	// default service-modeled logic will populate this option. This option can thus be
	// used to define a custom waiter state with fall-back to service-modeled waiter
	// state mutators.The function returns an error in case of a failure state. In case
	// of retry state, this function returns a bool value of true and nil error, while
	// in case of success it returns a bool value of false and nil error.
	Retryable func(context.Context, *GetInstanceProfileInput, *GetInstanceProfileOutput, error) (bool, error)
}

InstanceProfileExistsWaiterOptions are waiter options for InstanceProfileExistsWaiter

type ListAccessKeysAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListAccessKeysAPIClient interface {
	ListAccessKeys(context.Context, *ListAccessKeysInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccessKeysOutput, error)
}

ListAccessKeysAPIClient is a client that implements the ListAccessKeys operation.

type ListAccessKeysInput

type ListAccessKeysInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The name of the user. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ListAccessKeysOutput

type ListAccessKeysOutput struct {

	// A list of objects containing metadata about the access keys.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccessKeyMetadata []types.AccessKeyMetadata

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListAccessKeys request.

type ListAccessKeysPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListAccessKeysPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListAccessKeysPaginator is a paginator for ListAccessKeys

func NewListAccessKeysPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListAccessKeysPaginator(client ListAccessKeysAPIClient, params *ListAccessKeysInput, optFns ...func(*ListAccessKeysPaginatorOptions)) *ListAccessKeysPaginator

NewListAccessKeysPaginator returns a new ListAccessKeysPaginator

func (*ListAccessKeysPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAccessKeysPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListAccessKeysPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAccessKeysPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccessKeysOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListAccessKeys page.

type ListAccessKeysPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListAccessKeysPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListAccessKeysPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListAccessKeys

type ListAccountAliasesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListAccountAliasesAPIClient interface {
	ListAccountAliases(context.Context, *ListAccountAliasesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccountAliasesOutput, error)
}

ListAccountAliasesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListAccountAliases operation.

type ListAccountAliasesInput

type ListAccountAliasesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListAccountAliasesOutput

type ListAccountAliasesOutput struct {

	// A list of aliases associated with the account. AWS supports only one alias per
	// account.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccountAliases []string

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListAccountAliases request.

type ListAccountAliasesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListAccountAliasesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListAccountAliasesPaginator is a paginator for ListAccountAliases

func NewListAccountAliasesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListAccountAliasesPaginator(client ListAccountAliasesAPIClient, params *ListAccountAliasesInput, optFns ...func(*ListAccountAliasesPaginatorOptions)) *ListAccountAliasesPaginator

NewListAccountAliasesPaginator returns a new ListAccountAliasesPaginator

func (*ListAccountAliasesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAccountAliasesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListAccountAliasesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAccountAliasesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListAccountAliasesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListAccountAliases page.

type ListAccountAliasesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListAccountAliasesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListAccountAliasesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListAccountAliases

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListAttachedGroupPolicies(context.Context, *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListAttachedGroupPoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListAttachedGroupPolicies operation.

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the group to list attached policies for.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If it is
	// not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of the attached policies.
	AttachedPolicies []types.AttachedPolicy

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedGroupPolicies request.

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListAttachedGroupPolicies

func NewListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator returns a new ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator

func (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListAttachedGroupPolicies page.

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListAttachedGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListAttachedGroupPolicies

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListAttachedRolePolicies(context.Context, *ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListAttachedRolePoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListAttachedRolePolicies operation.

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the role to list attached policies for.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If it is
	// not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of the attached policies.
	AttachedPolicies []types.AttachedPolicy

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedRolePolicies request.

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListAttachedRolePolicies

func NewListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator returns a new ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator

func (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListAttachedRolePolicies page.

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListAttachedRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListAttachedRolePolicies

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListAttachedUserPolicies(context.Context, *ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListAttachedUserPoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListAttachedUserPolicies operation.

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesInput struct {

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the user to list attached policies for.
	// This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If it is
	// not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of the attached policies.
	AttachedPolicies []types.AttachedPolicy

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListAttachedUserPolicies request.

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListAttachedUserPolicies

func NewListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator returns a new ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator

func (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListAttachedUserPolicies page.

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListAttachedUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListAttachedUserPolicies

type ListEntitiesForPolicyAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListEntitiesForPolicyAPIClient interface {
	ListEntitiesForPolicy(context.Context, *ListEntitiesForPolicyInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput, error)
}

ListEntitiesForPolicyAPIClient is a client that implements the ListEntitiesForPolicy operation.

type ListEntitiesForPolicyInput

type ListEntitiesForPolicyInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy for which you want the
	// versions. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and
	// AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The entity type to use for filtering the results. For example, when EntityFilter
	// is Role, only the roles that are attached to the specified policy are returned.
	// This parameter is optional. If it is not included, all attached entities (users,
	// groups, and roles) are returned. The argument for this parameter must be one of
	// the valid values listed below.
	EntityFilter types.EntityType

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If it is
	// not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all entities. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string

	// The policy usage method to use for filtering the results. To list only
	// permissions policies, set PolicyUsageFilter to PermissionsPolicy. To list only
	// the policies used to set permissions boundaries, set the value to
	// PermissionsBoundary. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, all
	// policies are returned.
	PolicyUsageFilter types.PolicyUsageType
}

type ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput

type ListEntitiesForPolicyOutput struct {

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// A list of IAM groups that the policy is attached to.
	PolicyGroups []types.PolicyGroup

	// A list of IAM roles that the policy is attached to.
	PolicyRoles []types.PolicyRole

	// A list of IAM users that the policy is attached to.
	PolicyUsers []types.PolicyUser

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListEntitiesForPolicy request.

type ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator is a paginator for ListEntitiesForPolicy

func NewListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator returns a new ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator

func (*ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListEntitiesForPolicy page.

type ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListEntitiesForPolicyPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListEntitiesForPolicy

type ListGroupPoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupPoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListGroupPolicies(context.Context, *ListGroupPoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListGroupPoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListGroupPolicies operation.

type ListGroupPoliciesInput

type ListGroupPoliciesInput struct {

	// The name of the group to list policies for. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListGroupPoliciesOutput

type ListGroupPoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of policy names. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyNames []string

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListGroupPolicies request.

type ListGroupPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupPoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListGroupPoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListGroupPolicies

func NewListGroupPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListGroupPoliciesPaginator(client ListGroupPoliciesAPIClient, params *ListGroupPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*ListGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions)) *ListGroupPoliciesPaginator

NewListGroupPoliciesPaginator returns a new ListGroupPoliciesPaginator

func (*ListGroupPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListGroupPoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupPoliciesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupPoliciesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListGroupPolicies page.

type ListGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListGroupPoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListGroupPolicies

type ListGroupsAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsAPIClient interface {
	ListGroups(context.Context, *ListGroupsInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsOutput, error)
}

ListGroupsAPIClient is a client that implements the ListGroups operation.

type ListGroupsForUserAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsForUserAPIClient interface {
	ListGroupsForUser(context.Context, *ListGroupsForUserInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsForUserOutput, error)
}

ListGroupsForUserAPIClient is a client that implements the ListGroupsForUser operation.

type ListGroupsForUserInput

type ListGroupsForUserInput struct {

	// The name of the user to list groups for. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListGroupsForUserOutput

type ListGroupsForUserOutput struct {

	// A list of groups.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Groups []types.Group

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListGroupsForUser request.

type ListGroupsForUserPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsForUserPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListGroupsForUserPaginator is a paginator for ListGroupsForUser

func NewListGroupsForUserPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListGroupsForUserPaginator(client ListGroupsForUserAPIClient, params *ListGroupsForUserInput, optFns ...func(*ListGroupsForUserPaginatorOptions)) *ListGroupsForUserPaginator

NewListGroupsForUserPaginator returns a new ListGroupsForUserPaginator

func (*ListGroupsForUserPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupsForUserPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListGroupsForUserPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupsForUserPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsForUserOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListGroupsForUser page.

type ListGroupsForUserPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsForUserPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListGroupsForUserPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListGroupsForUser

type ListGroupsInput

type ListGroupsInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix
	// /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/ gets all groups whose path starts with
	// /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/. This parameter is optional. If it is not
	// included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all groups. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListGroupsOutput

type ListGroupsOutput struct {

	// A list of groups.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Groups []types.Group

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListGroups request.

type ListGroupsPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListGroupsPaginator is a paginator for ListGroups

func NewListGroupsPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListGroupsPaginator(client ListGroupsAPIClient, params *ListGroupsInput, optFns ...func(*ListGroupsPaginatorOptions)) *ListGroupsPaginator

NewListGroupsPaginator returns a new ListGroupsPaginator

func (*ListGroupsPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupsPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListGroupsPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListGroupsPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListGroupsOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListGroups page.

type ListGroupsPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListGroupsPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListGroupsPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListGroups

type ListInstanceProfilesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesAPIClient interface {
	ListInstanceProfiles(context.Context, *ListInstanceProfilesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListInstanceProfilesOutput, error)
}

ListInstanceProfilesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListInstanceProfiles operation.

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleAPIClient interface {
	ListInstanceProfilesForRole(context.Context, *ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput, error)
}

ListInstanceProfilesForRoleAPIClient is a client that implements the ListInstanceProfilesForRole operation.

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the role to list instance profiles for. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput

type ListInstanceProfilesForRoleOutput struct {

	// A list of instance profiles.
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfiles []types.InstanceProfile

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListInstanceProfilesForRole request.

type ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator is a paginator for ListInstanceProfilesForRole

func NewListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator returns a new ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator

func (*ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListInstanceProfilesForRole page.

type ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListInstanceProfilesForRolePaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListInstanceProfilesForRole

type ListInstanceProfilesInput

type ListInstanceProfilesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix
	// /application_abc/component_xyz/ gets all instance profiles whose path starts
	// with /application_abc/component_xyz/. This parameter is optional. If it is not
	// included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all instance profiles. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a
	// string that must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain
	// any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F),
	// including most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListInstanceProfilesOutput

type ListInstanceProfilesOutput struct {

	// A list of instance profiles.
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfiles []types.InstanceProfile

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListInstanceProfiles request.

type ListInstanceProfilesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListInstanceProfilesPaginator is a paginator for ListInstanceProfiles

func NewListInstanceProfilesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListInstanceProfilesPaginator returns a new ListInstanceProfilesPaginator

func (*ListInstanceProfilesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListInstanceProfilesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListInstanceProfilesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListInstanceProfiles page.

type ListInstanceProfilesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListInstanceProfilesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListInstanceProfilesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListInstanceProfiles

type ListMFADevicesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListMFADevicesAPIClient interface {
	ListMFADevices(context.Context, *ListMFADevicesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListMFADevicesOutput, error)
}

ListMFADevicesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListMFADevices operation.

type ListMFADevicesInput

type ListMFADevicesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The name of the user whose MFA devices you want to list. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ListMFADevicesOutput

type ListMFADevicesOutput struct {

	// A list of MFA devices.
	//
	// This member is required.
	MFADevices []types.MFADevice

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListMFADevices request.

type ListMFADevicesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListMFADevicesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListMFADevicesPaginator is a paginator for ListMFADevices

func NewListMFADevicesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListMFADevicesPaginator(client ListMFADevicesAPIClient, params *ListMFADevicesInput, optFns ...func(*ListMFADevicesPaginatorOptions)) *ListMFADevicesPaginator

NewListMFADevicesPaginator returns a new ListMFADevicesPaginator

func (*ListMFADevicesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListMFADevicesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListMFADevicesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListMFADevicesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListMFADevicesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListMFADevices page.

type ListMFADevicesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListMFADevicesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListMFADevicesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListMFADevices

type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput

type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersInput struct {
}

type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput

type ListOpenIDConnectProvidersOutput struct {

	// The list of IAM OIDC provider resource objects defined in the AWS account.
	OpenIDConnectProviderList []types.OpenIDConnectProviderListEntry

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListOpenIDConnectProviders request.

type ListPoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListPoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListPolicies(context.Context, *ListPoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListPoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListPoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListPolicies operation.

type ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessInput

type ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessInput struct {

	// The ARN of the IAM identity (user, group, or role) whose policies you want to
	// list.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Arn *string

	// The service namespace for the AWS services whose policies you want to list. To
	// learn the service namespace for a service, go to Actions, Resources, and
	// Condition Keys for AWS Services
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/reference_policies_actions-resources-contextkeys.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide. Choose the name of the service to view details for that
	// service. In the first paragraph, find the service prefix. For example, (service
	// prefix: a4b). For more information about service namespaces, see AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html#genref-aws-service-namespaces)
	// in the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceNamespaces []string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string
}

type ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessOutput

type ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessOutput struct {

	// A ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccess object that contains details about the
	// permissions policies attached to the specified identity (user, group, or role).
	//
	// This member is required.
	PoliciesGrantingServiceAccess []types.ListPoliciesGrantingServiceAccessEntry

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. We recommend that you check
	// IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ListPoliciesInput

type ListPoliciesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// A flag to filter the results to only the attached policies. When OnlyAttached is
	// true, the returned list contains only the policies that are attached to an IAM
	// user, group, or role. When OnlyAttached is false, or when the parameter is not
	// included, all policies are returned.
	OnlyAttached bool

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. This parameter is optional. If it is
	// not included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all policies. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string

	// The policy usage method to use for filtering the results. To list only
	// permissions policies, set PolicyUsageFilter to PermissionsPolicy. To list only
	// the policies used to set permissions boundaries, set the value to
	// PermissionsBoundary. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, all
	// policies are returned.
	PolicyUsageFilter types.PolicyUsageType

	// The scope to use for filtering the results. To list only AWS managed policies,
	// set Scope to AWS. To list only the customer managed policies in your AWS
	// account, set Scope to Local. This parameter is optional. If it is not included,
	// or if it is set to All, all policies are returned.
	Scope types.PolicyScopeType
}

type ListPoliciesOutput

type ListPoliciesOutput struct {

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// A list of policies.
	Policies []types.Policy

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListPolicies request.

type ListPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListPoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListPoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListPolicies

func NewListPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListPoliciesPaginator(client ListPoliciesAPIClient, params *ListPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*ListPoliciesPaginatorOptions)) *ListPoliciesPaginator

NewListPoliciesPaginator returns a new ListPoliciesPaginator

func (*ListPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListPoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListPoliciesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListPoliciesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListPolicies page.

type ListPoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListPoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListPoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListPolicies

type ListPolicyVersionsAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListPolicyVersionsAPIClient interface {
	ListPolicyVersions(context.Context, *ListPolicyVersionsInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, error)
}

ListPolicyVersionsAPIClient is a client that implements the ListPolicyVersions operation.

type ListPolicyVersionsInput

type ListPolicyVersionsInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy for which you want the
	// versions. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and
	// AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListPolicyVersionsOutput

type ListPolicyVersionsOutput struct {

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// A list of policy versions. For more information about managed policy versions,
	// see Versioning for Managed Policies
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	Versions []types.PolicyVersion

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListPolicyVersions request.

type ListPolicyVersionsPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListPolicyVersionsPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListPolicyVersionsPaginator is a paginator for ListPolicyVersions

func NewListPolicyVersionsPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListPolicyVersionsPaginator(client ListPolicyVersionsAPIClient, params *ListPolicyVersionsInput, optFns ...func(*ListPolicyVersionsPaginatorOptions)) *ListPolicyVersionsPaginator

NewListPolicyVersionsPaginator returns a new ListPolicyVersionsPaginator

func (*ListPolicyVersionsPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListPolicyVersionsPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListPolicyVersionsPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListPolicyVersionsPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListPolicyVersionsOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListPolicyVersions page.

type ListPolicyVersionsPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListPolicyVersionsPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListPolicyVersionsPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListPolicyVersions

type ListRolePoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListRolePoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListRolePolicies(context.Context, *ListRolePoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolePoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListRolePoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListRolePolicies operation.

type ListRolePoliciesInput

type ListRolePoliciesInput struct {

	// The name of the role to list policies for. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListRolePoliciesOutput

type ListRolePoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of policy names.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyNames []string

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListRolePolicies request.

type ListRolePoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListRolePoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListRolePoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListRolePolicies

func NewListRolePoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListRolePoliciesPaginator(client ListRolePoliciesAPIClient, params *ListRolePoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*ListRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions)) *ListRolePoliciesPaginator

NewListRolePoliciesPaginator returns a new ListRolePoliciesPaginator

func (*ListRolePoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListRolePoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListRolePoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListRolePoliciesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolePoliciesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListRolePolicies page.

type ListRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListRolePoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListRolePolicies

type ListRoleTagsInput

type ListRoleTagsInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM role for which you want to see the list of tags. This
	// parameter accepts (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex))
	// a string of characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric
	// characters with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters:
	// _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number
	// of items that you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the
	// maximum that you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do
	// not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when more results are available. In that case, the IsTruncated
	// response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to include in the
	// subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListRoleTagsOutput

type ListRoleTagsOutput struct {

	// The list of tags currently that is attached to the role. Each tag consists of a
	// key name and an associated value. If no tags are attached to the specified role,
	// the response contains an empty list.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Tags []types.Tag

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can use the Marker request parameter to make a subsequent
	// pagination request that retrieves more items. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// than the MaxItems number of results even when more results are available. Check
	// IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive all of your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ListRolesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListRolesAPIClient interface {
	ListRoles(context.Context, *ListRolesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolesOutput, error)
}

ListRolesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListRoles operation.

type ListRolesInput

type ListRolesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. For example, the prefix
	// /application_abc/component_xyz/ gets all roles whose path starts with
	// /application_abc/component_xyz/. This parameter is optional. If it is not
	// included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all roles. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListRolesOutput

type ListRolesOutput struct {

	// A list of roles.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Roles []types.Role

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListRoles request.

type ListRolesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListRolesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListRolesPaginator is a paginator for ListRoles

func NewListRolesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListRolesPaginator(client ListRolesAPIClient, params *ListRolesInput, optFns ...func(*ListRolesPaginatorOptions)) *ListRolesPaginator

NewListRolesPaginator returns a new ListRolesPaginator

func (*ListRolesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListRolesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListRolesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListRolesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListRolesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListRoles page.

type ListRolesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListRolesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListRolesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListRoles

type ListSAMLProvidersInput

type ListSAMLProvidersInput struct {
}

type ListSAMLProvidersOutput

type ListSAMLProvidersOutput struct {

	// The list of SAML provider resource objects defined in IAM for this AWS account.
	SAMLProviderList []types.SAMLProviderListEntry

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListSAMLProviders request.

type ListSSHPublicKeysAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListSSHPublicKeysAPIClient interface {
	ListSSHPublicKeys(context.Context, *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, error)
}

ListSSHPublicKeysAPIClient is a client that implements the ListSSHPublicKeys operation.

type ListSSHPublicKeysInput

type ListSSHPublicKeysInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The name of the IAM user to list SSH public keys for. If none is specified, the
	// UserName field is determined implicitly based on the AWS access key used to sign
	// the request. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ListSSHPublicKeysOutput

type ListSSHPublicKeysOutput struct {

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// A list of the SSH public keys assigned to IAM user.
	SSHPublicKeys []types.SSHPublicKeyMetadata

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListSSHPublicKeys request.

type ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator is a paginator for ListSSHPublicKeys

func NewListSSHPublicKeysPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListSSHPublicKeysPaginator(client ListSSHPublicKeysAPIClient, params *ListSSHPublicKeysInput, optFns ...func(*ListSSHPublicKeysPaginatorOptions)) *ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator

NewListSSHPublicKeysPaginator returns a new ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator

func (*ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListSSHPublicKeysPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListSSHPublicKeysOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListSSHPublicKeys page.

type ListSSHPublicKeysPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListSSHPublicKeysPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListSSHPublicKeysPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListSSHPublicKeys

type ListServerCertificatesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListServerCertificatesAPIClient interface {
	ListServerCertificates(context.Context, *ListServerCertificatesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListServerCertificatesOutput, error)
}

ListServerCertificatesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListServerCertificates operation.

type ListServerCertificatesInput

type ListServerCertificatesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. For example: /company/servercerts
	// would get all server certificates for which the path starts with
	// /company/servercerts. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it
	// defaults to a slash (/), listing all server certificates. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListServerCertificatesOutput

type ListServerCertificatesOutput struct {

	// A list of server certificates.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificateMetadataList []types.ServerCertificateMetadata

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListServerCertificates request.

type ListServerCertificatesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListServerCertificatesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListServerCertificatesPaginator is a paginator for ListServerCertificates

func NewListServerCertificatesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListServerCertificatesPaginator returns a new ListServerCertificatesPaginator

func (*ListServerCertificatesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListServerCertificatesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListServerCertificatesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListServerCertificates page.

type ListServerCertificatesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListServerCertificatesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListServerCertificatesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListServerCertificates

type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput

type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsInput struct {

	// Filters the returned results to only those for the specified AWS service. If not
	// specified, then AWS returns service-specific credentials for all services.
	ServiceName *string

	// The name of the user whose service-specific credentials you want information
	// about. If this value is not specified, then the operation assumes the user whose
	// credentials are used to call the operation. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput

type ListServiceSpecificCredentialsOutput struct {

	// A list of structures that each contain details about a service-specific
	// credential.
	ServiceSpecificCredentials []types.ServiceSpecificCredentialMetadata

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ListSigningCertificatesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListSigningCertificatesAPIClient interface {
	ListSigningCertificates(context.Context, *ListSigningCertificatesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListSigningCertificatesOutput, error)
}

ListSigningCertificatesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListSigningCertificates operation.

type ListSigningCertificatesInput

type ListSigningCertificatesInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The name of the IAM user whose signing certificates you want to examine. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters
	// with no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ListSigningCertificatesOutput

type ListSigningCertificatesOutput struct {

	// A list of the user's signing certificate information.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Certificates []types.SigningCertificate

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListSigningCertificates request.

type ListSigningCertificatesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListSigningCertificatesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListSigningCertificatesPaginator is a paginator for ListSigningCertificates

func NewListSigningCertificatesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListSigningCertificatesPaginator returns a new ListSigningCertificatesPaginator

func (*ListSigningCertificatesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListSigningCertificatesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListSigningCertificatesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListSigningCertificates page.

type ListSigningCertificatesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListSigningCertificatesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListSigningCertificatesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListSigningCertificates

type ListUserPoliciesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListUserPoliciesAPIClient interface {
	ListUserPolicies(context.Context, *ListUserPoliciesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListUserPoliciesOutput, error)
}

ListUserPoliciesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListUserPolicies operation.

type ListUserPoliciesInput

type ListUserPoliciesInput struct {

	// The name of the user to list policies for. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListUserPoliciesOutput

type ListUserPoliciesOutput struct {

	// A list of policy names.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyNames []string

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListUserPolicies request.

type ListUserPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListUserPoliciesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListUserPoliciesPaginator is a paginator for ListUserPolicies

func NewListUserPoliciesPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListUserPoliciesPaginator(client ListUserPoliciesAPIClient, params *ListUserPoliciesInput, optFns ...func(*ListUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions)) *ListUserPoliciesPaginator

NewListUserPoliciesPaginator returns a new ListUserPoliciesPaginator

func (*ListUserPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListUserPoliciesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListUserPoliciesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListUserPoliciesPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListUserPoliciesOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListUserPolicies page.

type ListUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListUserPoliciesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListUserPolicies

type ListUserTagsInput

type ListUserTagsInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM user whose tags you want to see. This parameter accepts
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// (Optional) Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number
	// of items that you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the
	// maximum that you specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do
	// not include this parameter, it defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when more results are available. In that case, the IsTruncated
	// response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to include in the
	// subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListUserTagsOutput

type ListUserTagsOutput struct {

	// The list of tags that are currently attached to the user. Each tag consists of a
	// key name and an associated value. If no tags are attached to the specified user,
	// the response contains an empty list.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Tags []types.Tag

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can use the Marker request parameter to make a subsequent
	// pagination request that retrieves more items. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// than the MaxItems number of results even when more results are available. Check
	// IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive all of your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ListUsersAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListUsersAPIClient interface {
	ListUsers(context.Context, *ListUsersInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListUsersOutput, error)
}

ListUsersAPIClient is a client that implements the ListUsers operation.

type ListUsersInput

type ListUsersInput struct {

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The path prefix for filtering the results. For example:
	// /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/, which would get all user names whose path starts
	// with /division_abc/subdivision_xyz/. This parameter is optional. If it is not
	// included, it defaults to a slash (/), listing all user names. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a string that
	// must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII
	// character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F), including most
	// punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	PathPrefix *string
}

type ListUsersOutput

type ListUsersOutput struct {

	// A list of users.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Users []types.User

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListUsers request.

type ListUsersPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListUsersPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListUsersPaginator is a paginator for ListUsers

func NewListUsersPaginator added in v0.30.0

func NewListUsersPaginator(client ListUsersAPIClient, params *ListUsersInput, optFns ...func(*ListUsersPaginatorOptions)) *ListUsersPaginator

NewListUsersPaginator returns a new ListUsersPaginator

func (*ListUsersPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListUsersPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListUsersPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListUsersPaginator) NextPage(ctx context.Context, optFns ...func(*Options)) (*ListUsersOutput, error)

NextPage retrieves the next ListUsers page.

type ListUsersPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListUsersPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListUsersPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListUsers

type ListVirtualMFADevicesAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type ListVirtualMFADevicesAPIClient interface {
	ListVirtualMFADevices(context.Context, *ListVirtualMFADevicesInput, ...func(*Options)) (*ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput, error)
}

ListVirtualMFADevicesAPIClient is a client that implements the ListVirtualMFADevices operation.

type ListVirtualMFADevicesInput

type ListVirtualMFADevicesInput struct {

	// The status (Unassigned or Assigned) of the devices to list. If you do not
	// specify an AssignmentStatus, the operation defaults to Any, which lists both
	// assigned and unassigned virtual MFA devices.,
	AssignmentStatus types.AssignmentStatusType

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32
}

type ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput

type ListVirtualMFADevicesOutput struct {

	// The list of virtual MFA devices in the current account that match the
	// AssignmentStatus value that was passed in the request.
	//
	// This member is required.
	VirtualMFADevices []types.VirtualMFADevice

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful ListVirtualMFADevices request.

type ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator added in v0.30.0

type ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator is a paginator for ListVirtualMFADevices

func NewListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator returns a new ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator

func (*ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next ListVirtualMFADevices page.

type ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

ListVirtualMFADevicesPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for ListVirtualMFADevices

type Options

type Options struct {
	// Set of options to modify how an operation is invoked. These apply to all
	// operations invoked for this client. Use functional options on operation call to
	// modify this list for per operation behavior.
	APIOptions []func(*middleware.Stack) error

	// Configures the events that will be sent to the configured logger.
	ClientLogMode aws.ClientLogMode

	// The credentials object to use when signing requests.
	Credentials aws.CredentialsProvider

	// The endpoint options to be used when attempting to resolve an endpoint.
	EndpointOptions EndpointResolverOptions

	// The service endpoint resolver.
	EndpointResolver EndpointResolver

	// Signature Version 4 (SigV4) Signer
	HTTPSignerV4 HTTPSignerV4

	// The logger writer interface to write logging messages to.
	Logger logging.Logger

	// The region to send requests to. (Required)
	Region string

	// Retryer guides how HTTP requests should be retried in case of recoverable
	// failures. When nil the API client will use a default retryer.
	Retryer aws.Retryer

	// The HTTP client to invoke API calls with. Defaults to client's default HTTP
	// implementation if nil.
	HTTPClient HTTPClient
}

func (Options) Copy

func (o Options) Copy() Options

Copy creates a clone where the APIOptions list is deep copied.

type PutGroupPolicyInput

type PutGroupPolicyInput struct {

	// The name of the group to associate the policy with. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-.
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The policy document. You must provide policies in JSON format in IAM. However,
	// for AWS CloudFormation templates formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy
	// in JSON or YAML format. AWS CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON
	// format before submitting it to IAM. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy document. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string
}

type PutGroupPolicyOutput

type PutGroupPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type PutRolePermissionsBoundaryInput

type PutRolePermissionsBoundaryInput struct {

	// The ARN of the policy that is used to set the permissions boundary for the role.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PermissionsBoundary *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM role for which you want to set the
	// permissions boundary.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type PutRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput

type PutRolePermissionsBoundaryOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type PutRolePolicyInput

type PutRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The policy document. You must provide policies in JSON format in IAM. However,
	// for AWS CloudFormation templates formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy
	// in JSON or YAML format. AWS CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON
	// format before submitting it to IAM. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy document. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name of the role to associate the policy with. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type PutRolePolicyOutput

type PutRolePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type PutUserPermissionsBoundaryInput

type PutUserPermissionsBoundaryInput struct {

	// The ARN of the policy that is used to set the permissions boundary for the user.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PermissionsBoundary *string

	// The name (friendly name, not ARN) of the IAM user for which you want to set the
	// permissions boundary.
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type PutUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput

type PutUserPermissionsBoundaryOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type PutUserPolicyInput

type PutUserPolicyInput struct {

	// The policy document. You must provide policies in JSON format in IAM. However,
	// for AWS CloudFormation templates formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy
	// in JSON or YAML format. AWS CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON
	// format before submitting it to IAM. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the policy document. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyName *string

	// The name of the user to associate the policy with. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type PutUserPolicyOutput

type PutUserPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput

type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderInput struct {

	// The client ID (also known as audience) to remove from the IAM OIDC provider
	// resource. For more information about client IDs, see
	// CreateOpenIDConnectProvider.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ClientID *string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OIDC provider resource to remove the
	// client ID from. You can get a list of OIDC provider ARNs by using the
	// ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation. For more information about ARNs, see
	// Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string
}

type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput

type RemoveClientIDFromOpenIDConnectProviderOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput

type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the instance profile to update. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	InstanceProfileName *string

	// The name of the role to remove. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput

type RemoveRoleFromInstanceProfileOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type RemoveUserFromGroupInput

type RemoveUserFromGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the group to update. This parameter allows (through its regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of
	// upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include
	// any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// The name of the user to remove. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type RemoveUserFromGroupOutput

type RemoveUserFromGroupOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput

type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct {

	// The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. If
	// this value is not specified, then the operation assumes the user whose
	// credentials are used to call the operation. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters
	// consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You
	// can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput

type ResetServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct {

	// A structure with details about the updated service-specific credential,
	// including the new password. This is the only time that you can access the
	// password. You cannot recover the password later, but you can reset it again.
	ServiceSpecificCredential *types.ServiceSpecificCredential

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type ResolveEndpoint

type ResolveEndpoint struct {
	Resolver EndpointResolver
	Options  EndpointResolverOptions
}

func (*ResolveEndpoint) HandleSerialize

func (*ResolveEndpoint) ID

func (*ResolveEndpoint) ID() string

type ResyncMFADeviceInput

type ResyncMFADeviceInput struct {

	// An authentication code emitted by the device. The format for this parameter is a
	// sequence of six digits.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AuthenticationCode1 *string

	// A subsequent authentication code emitted by the device. The format for this
	// parameter is a sequence of six digits.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AuthenticationCode2 *string

	// Serial number that uniquely identifies the MFA device. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	SerialNumber *string

	// The name of the user whose MFA device you want to resynchronize. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type ResyncMFADeviceOutput

type ResyncMFADeviceOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput

type SetDefaultPolicyVersionInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM policy whose default version you want
	// to set. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and
	// AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyArn *string

	// The version of the policy to set as the default (operative) version. For more
	// information about managed policy versions, see Versioning for Managed Policies
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/policies-managed-versions.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	//
	// This member is required.
	VersionId *string
}

type SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput

type SetDefaultPolicyVersionOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesInput

type SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesInput struct {

	// The version of the global endpoint token. Version 1 tokens are valid only in AWS
	// Regions that are available by default. These tokens do not work in manually
	// enabled Regions, such as Asia Pacific (Hong Kong). Version 2 tokens are valid in
	// all Regions. However, version 2 tokens are longer and might affect systems where
	// you temporarily store tokens. For information, see Activating and Deactivating
	// STS in an AWS Region
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_credentials_temp_enable-regions.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide.
	//
	// This member is required.
	GlobalEndpointTokenVersion types.GlobalEndpointTokenVersion
}

type SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesOutput

type SetSecurityTokenServicePreferencesOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type SimulateCustomPolicyAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type SimulateCustomPolicyAPIClient interface {
	SimulateCustomPolicy(context.Context, *SimulateCustomPolicyInput, ...func(*Options)) (*SimulateCustomPolicyOutput, error)
}

SimulateCustomPolicyAPIClient is a client that implements the SimulateCustomPolicy operation.

type SimulateCustomPolicyInput

type SimulateCustomPolicyInput struct {

	// A list of names of API operations to evaluate in the simulation. Each operation
	// is evaluated against each resource. Each operation must include the service
	// identifier, such as iam:CreateUser. This operation does not support using
	// wildcards (*) in an action name.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ActionNames []string

	// A list of policy documents to include in the simulation. Each document is
	// specified as a string containing the complete, valid JSON text of an IAM policy.
	// Do not include any resource-based policies in this parameter. Any resource-based
	// policy must be submitted with the ResourcePolicy parameter. The policies cannot
	// be "scope-down" policies, such as you could include in a call to
	// GetFederationToken
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/APIReference/API_GetFederationToken.html)
	// or one of the AssumeRole
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/APIReference/API_AssumeRole.html) API
	// operations. In other words, do not use policies designed to restrict what a user
	// can do while using the temporary credentials. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyInputList []string

	// The ARN of the IAM user that you want to use as the simulated caller of the API
	// operations. CallerArn is required if you include a ResourcePolicy so that the
	// policy's Principal element has a value to use in evaluating the policy. You can
	// specify only the ARN of an IAM user. You cannot specify the ARN of an assumed
	// role, federated user, or a service principal.
	CallerArn *string

	// A list of context keys and corresponding values for the simulation to use.
	// Whenever a context key is evaluated in one of the simulated IAM permissions
	// policies, the corresponding value is supplied.
	ContextEntries []types.ContextEntry

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The IAM permissions boundary policy to simulate. The permissions boundary sets
	// the maximum permissions that an IAM entity can have. You can input only one
	// permissions boundary when you pass a policy to this operation. For more
	// information about permissions boundaries, see Permissions Boundaries for IAM
	// Entities
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_boundaries.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide. The policy input is specified as a string that contains
	// the complete, valid JSON text of a permissions boundary policy. The regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a
	// string of characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII
	// character ranging from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII
	// character range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1
	// Supplement character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab
	// (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	PermissionsBoundaryPolicyInputList []string

	// A list of ARNs of AWS resources to include in the simulation. If this parameter
	// is not provided, then the value defaults to * (all resources). Each API in the
	// ActionNames parameter is evaluated for each resource in this list. The
	// simulation determines the access result (allowed or denied) of each combination
	// and reports it in the response. The simulation does not automatically retrieve
	// policies for the specified resources. If you want to include a resource policy
	// in the simulation, then you must include the policy as a string in the
	// ResourcePolicy parameter. If you include a ResourcePolicy, then it must be
	// applicable to all of the resources included in the simulation or you receive an
	// invalid input error. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names
	// (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	ResourceArns []string

	// Specifies the type of simulation to run. Different API operations that support
	// resource-based policies require different combinations of resources. By
	// specifying the type of simulation to run, you enable the policy simulator to
	// enforce the presence of the required resources to ensure reliable simulation
	// results. If your simulation does not match one of the following scenarios, then
	// you can omit this parameter. The following list shows each of the supported
	// scenario values and the resources that you must define to run the simulation.
	// Each of the EC2 scenarios requires that you specify instance, image, and
	// security-group resources. If your scenario includes an EBS volume, then you must
	// specify that volume as a resource. If the EC2 scenario includes VPC, then you
	// must supply the network-interface resource. If it includes an IP subnet, then
	// you must specify the subnet resource. For more information on the EC2 scenario
	// options, see Supported Platforms
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/UserGuide/ec2-supported-platforms.html)
	// in the Amazon EC2 User Guide.
	//
	// * EC2-Classic-InstanceStore instance, image,
	// security-group
	//
	// * EC2-Classic-EBS instance, image, security-group, volume
	//
	// *
	// EC2-VPC-InstanceStore instance, image, security-group, network-interface
	//
	// *
	// EC2-VPC-InstanceStore-Subnet instance, image, security-group, network-interface,
	// subnet
	//
	// * EC2-VPC-EBS instance, image, security-group, network-interface,
	// volume
	//
	// * EC2-VPC-EBS-Subnet instance, image, security-group, network-interface,
	// subnet, volume
	ResourceHandlingOption *string

	// An ARN representing the AWS account ID that specifies the owner of any simulated
	// resource that does not identify its owner in the resource ARN. Examples of
	// resource ARNs include an S3 bucket or object. If ResourceOwner is specified, it
	// is also used as the account owner of any ResourcePolicy included in the
	// simulation. If the ResourceOwner parameter is not specified, then the owner of
	// the resources and the resource policy defaults to the account of the identity
	// provided in CallerArn. This parameter is required only if you specify a
	// resource-based policy and account that owns the resource is different from the
	// account that owns the simulated calling user CallerArn. The ARN for an account
	// uses the following syntax: arn:aws:iam::AWS-account-ID:root. For example, to
	// represent the account with the 112233445566 ID, use the following ARN:
	// arn:aws:iam::112233445566-ID:root.
	ResourceOwner *string

	// A resource-based policy to include in the simulation provided as a string. Each
	// resource in the simulation is treated as if it had this policy attached. You can
	// include only one resource-based policy in a simulation. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	ResourcePolicy *string
}

type SimulateCustomPolicyOutput

type SimulateCustomPolicyOutput struct {

	// The results of the simulation.
	EvaluationResults []types.EvaluationResult

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful SimulatePrincipalPolicy or SimulateCustomPolicy request.

type SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

type SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator is a paginator for SimulateCustomPolicy

func NewSimulateCustomPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewSimulateCustomPolicyPaginator returns a new SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator

func (*SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*SimulateCustomPolicyPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next SimulateCustomPolicy page.

type SimulateCustomPolicyPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type SimulateCustomPolicyPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

SimulateCustomPolicyPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for SimulateCustomPolicy

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyAPIClient added in v0.30.0

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyAPIClient interface {
	SimulatePrincipalPolicy(context.Context, *SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput, ...func(*Options)) (*SimulatePrincipalPolicyOutput, error)
}

SimulatePrincipalPolicyAPIClient is a client that implements the SimulatePrincipalPolicy operation.

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyInput struct {

	// A list of names of API operations to evaluate in the simulation. Each operation
	// is evaluated for each resource. Each operation must include the service
	// identifier, such as iam:CreateUser.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ActionNames []string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of a user, group, or role whose policies you want
	// to include in the simulation. If you specify a user, group, or role, the
	// simulation includes all policies that are associated with that entity. If you
	// specify a user, the simulation also includes all policies that are attached to
	// any groups the user belongs to. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon
	// Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicySourceArn *string

	// The ARN of the IAM user that you want to specify as the simulated caller of the
	// API operations. If you do not specify a CallerArn, it defaults to the ARN of the
	// user that you specify in PolicySourceArn, if you specified a user. If you
	// include both a PolicySourceArn (for example,
	// arn:aws:iam::123456789012:user/David) and a CallerArn (for example,
	// arn:aws:iam::123456789012:user/Bob), the result is that you simulate calling the
	// API operations as Bob, as if Bob had David's policies. You can specify only the
	// ARN of an IAM user. You cannot specify the ARN of an assumed role, federated
	// user, or a service principal. CallerArn is required if you include a
	// ResourcePolicy and the PolicySourceArn is not the ARN for an IAM user. This is
	// required so that the resource-based policy's Principal element has a value to
	// use in evaluating the policy. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon
	// Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	CallerArn *string

	// A list of context keys and corresponding values for the simulation to use.
	// Whenever a context key is evaluated in one of the simulated IAM permissions
	// policies, the corresponding value is supplied.
	ContextEntries []types.ContextEntry

	// Use this parameter only when paginating results and only after you receive a
	// response indicating that the results are truncated. Set it to the value of the
	// Marker element in the response that you received to indicate where the next call
	// should start.
	Marker *string

	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	MaxItems *int32

	// The IAM permissions boundary policy to simulate. The permissions boundary sets
	// the maximum permissions that the entity can have. You can input only one
	// permissions boundary when you pass a policy to this operation. An IAM entity can
	// only have one permissions boundary in effect at a time. For example, if a
	// permissions boundary is attached to an entity and you pass in a different
	// permissions boundary policy using this parameter, then the new permissions
	// boundary policy is used for the simulation. For more information about
	// permissions boundaries, see Permissions Boundaries for IAM Entities
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/access_policies_boundaries.html)
	// in the IAM User Guide. The policy input is specified as a string containing the
	// complete, valid JSON text of a permissions boundary policy. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	PermissionsBoundaryPolicyInputList []string

	// An optional list of additional policy documents to include in the simulation.
	// Each document is specified as a string containing the complete, valid JSON text
	// of an IAM policy. The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to
	// validate this parameter is a string of characters consisting of the
	// following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging from the space character
	// (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character range
	//
	// * The printable
	// characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement character set (through
	// \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage
	// return (\u000D)
	PolicyInputList []string

	// A list of ARNs of AWS resources to include in the simulation. If this parameter
	// is not provided, then the value defaults to * (all resources). Each API in the
	// ActionNames parameter is evaluated for each resource in this list. The
	// simulation determines the access result (allowed or denied) of each combination
	// and reports it in the response. The simulation does not automatically retrieve
	// policies for the specified resources. If you want to include a resource policy
	// in the simulation, then you must include the policy as a string in the
	// ResourcePolicy parameter. For more information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource
	// Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	ResourceArns []string

	// Specifies the type of simulation to run. Different API operations that support
	// resource-based policies require different combinations of resources. By
	// specifying the type of simulation to run, you enable the policy simulator to
	// enforce the presence of the required resources to ensure reliable simulation
	// results. If your simulation does not match one of the following scenarios, then
	// you can omit this parameter. The following list shows each of the supported
	// scenario values and the resources that you must define to run the simulation.
	// Each of the EC2 scenarios requires that you specify instance, image, and
	// security group resources. If your scenario includes an EBS volume, then you must
	// specify that volume as a resource. If the EC2 scenario includes VPC, then you
	// must supply the network interface resource. If it includes an IP subnet, then
	// you must specify the subnet resource. For more information on the EC2 scenario
	// options, see Supported Platforms
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AWSEC2/latest/UserGuide/ec2-supported-platforms.html)
	// in the Amazon EC2 User Guide.
	//
	// * EC2-Classic-InstanceStore instance, image,
	// security group
	//
	// * EC2-Classic-EBS instance, image, security group, volume
	//
	// *
	// EC2-VPC-InstanceStore instance, image, security group, network interface
	//
	// *
	// EC2-VPC-InstanceStore-Subnet instance, image, security group, network interface,
	// subnet
	//
	// * EC2-VPC-EBS instance, image, security group, network interface,
	// volume
	//
	// * EC2-VPC-EBS-Subnet instance, image, security group, network interface,
	// subnet, volume
	ResourceHandlingOption *string

	// An AWS account ID that specifies the owner of any simulated resource that does
	// not identify its owner in the resource ARN. Examples of resource ARNs include an
	// S3 bucket or object. If ResourceOwner is specified, it is also used as the
	// account owner of any ResourcePolicy included in the simulation. If the
	// ResourceOwner parameter is not specified, then the owner of the resources and
	// the resource policy defaults to the account of the identity provided in
	// CallerArn. This parameter is required only if you specify a resource-based
	// policy and account that owns the resource is different from the account that
	// owns the simulated calling user CallerArn.
	ResourceOwner *string

	// A resource-based policy to include in the simulation provided as a string. Each
	// resource in the simulation is treated as if it had this policy attached. You can
	// include only one resource-based policy in a simulation. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	ResourcePolicy *string
}

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyOutput

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyOutput struct {

	// The results of the simulation.
	EvaluationResults []types.EvaluationResult

	// A flag that indicates whether there are more items to return. If your results
	// were truncated, you can make a subsequent pagination request using the Marker
	// request parameter to retrieve more items. Note that IAM might return fewer than
	// the MaxItems number of results even when there are more results available. We
	// recommend that you check IsTruncated after every call to ensure that you receive
	// all your results.
	IsTruncated bool

	// When IsTruncated is true, this element is present and contains the value to use
	// for the Marker parameter in a subsequent pagination request.
	Marker *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful SimulatePrincipalPolicy or SimulateCustomPolicy request.

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator is a paginator for SimulatePrincipalPolicy

func NewSimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator added in v0.30.0

NewSimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator returns a new SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator

func (*SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages added in v0.30.0

func (p *SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator) HasMorePages() bool

HasMorePages returns a boolean indicating whether more pages are available

func (*SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginator) NextPage added in v0.30.0

NextPage retrieves the next SimulatePrincipalPolicy page.

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginatorOptions added in v0.30.0

type SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginatorOptions struct {
	// Use this only when paginating results to indicate the maximum number of items
	// you want in the response. If additional items exist beyond the maximum you
	// specify, the IsTruncated response element is true. If you do not include this
	// parameter, the number of items defaults to 100. Note that IAM might return fewer
	// results, even when there are more results available. In that case, the
	// IsTruncated response element returns true, and Marker contains a value to
	// include in the subsequent call that tells the service where to continue from.
	Limit int32

	// Set to true if pagination should stop if the service returns a pagination token
	// that matches the most recent token provided to the service.
	StopOnDuplicateToken bool
}

SimulatePrincipalPolicyPaginatorOptions is the paginator options for SimulatePrincipalPolicy

type TagRoleInput

type TagRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the role that you want to add tags to. This parameter accepts
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// The list of tags that you want to attach to the role. Each tag consists of a key
	// name and an associated value. You can specify this with a JSON string.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Tags []types.Tag
}

type TagRoleOutput

type TagRoleOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type TagUserInput

type TagUserInput struct {

	// The list of tags that you want to attach to the user. Each tag consists of a key
	// name and an associated value.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Tags []types.Tag

	// The name of the user that you want to add tags to. This parameter accepts
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type TagUserOutput

type TagUserOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UntagRoleInput

type UntagRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the IAM role from which you want to remove tags. This parameter
	// accepts (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string
	// of characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with
	// no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// A list of key names as a simple array of strings. The tags with matching keys
	// are removed from the specified role.
	//
	// This member is required.
	TagKeys []string
}

type UntagRoleOutput

type UntagRoleOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UntagUserInput

type UntagUserInput struct {

	// A list of key names as a simple array of strings. The tags with matching keys
	// are removed from the specified user.
	//
	// This member is required.
	TagKeys []string

	// The name of the IAM user from which you want to remove tags. This parameter
	// accepts (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string
	// of characters that consist of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with
	// no spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: =,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type UntagUserOutput

type UntagUserOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateAccessKeyInput

type UpdateAccessKeyInput struct {

	// The access key ID of the secret access key you want to update. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	AccessKeyId *string

	// The status you want to assign to the secret access key. Active means that the
	// key can be used for API calls to AWS, while Inactive means that the key cannot
	// be used.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Status types.StatusType

	// The name of the user whose key you want to update. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type UpdateAccessKeyOutput

type UpdateAccessKeyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput

type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyInput struct {

	// Allows all IAM users in your account to use the AWS Management Console to change
	// their own passwords. For more information, see Letting IAM Users Change Their
	// Own Passwords
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/HowToPwdIAMUser.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. If you do not specify a value for this parameter, then the
	// operation uses the default value of false. The result is that IAM users in the
	// account do not automatically have permissions to change their own password.
	AllowUsersToChangePassword bool

	// Prevents IAM users from setting a new password after their password has expired.
	// The IAM user cannot be accessed until an administrator resets the password. If
	// you do not specify a value for this parameter, then the operation uses the
	// default value of false. The result is that IAM users can change their passwords
	// after they expire and continue to sign in as the user.
	HardExpiry *bool

	// The number of days that an IAM user password is valid. If you do not specify a
	// value for this parameter, then the operation uses the default value of 0. The
	// result is that IAM user passwords never expire.
	MaxPasswordAge *int32

	// The minimum number of characters allowed in an IAM user password. If you do not
	// specify a value for this parameter, then the operation uses the default value of
	// 6.
	MinimumPasswordLength *int32

	// Specifies the number of previous passwords that IAM users are prevented from
	// reusing. If you do not specify a value for this parameter, then the operation
	// uses the default value of 0. The result is that IAM users are not prevented from
	// reusing previous passwords.
	PasswordReusePrevention *int32

	// Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one lowercase
	// character from the ISO basic Latin alphabet (a to z). If you do not specify a
	// value for this parameter, then the operation uses the default value of false.
	// The result is that passwords do not require at least one lowercase character.
	RequireLowercaseCharacters bool

	// Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one numeric character
	// (0 to 9). If you do not specify a value for this parameter, then the operation
	// uses the default value of false. The result is that passwords do not require at
	// least one numeric character.
	RequireNumbers bool

	// Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one of the following
	// non-alphanumeric characters: ! @ # $ % ^ & * ( ) _ + - = [ ] { } | ' If you do
	// not specify a value for this parameter, then the operation uses the default
	// value of false. The result is that passwords do not require at least one symbol
	// character.
	RequireSymbols bool

	// Specifies whether IAM user passwords must contain at least one uppercase
	// character from the ISO basic Latin alphabet (A to Z). If you do not specify a
	// value for this parameter, then the operation uses the default value of false.
	// The result is that passwords do not require at least one uppercase character.
	RequireUppercaseCharacters bool
}

type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput

type UpdateAccountPasswordPolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput

type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyInput struct {

	// The policy that grants an entity permission to assume the role. You must provide
	// policies in JSON format in IAM. However, for AWS CloudFormation templates
	// formatted in YAML, you can provide the policy in JSON or YAML format. AWS
	// CloudFormation always converts a YAML policy to JSON format before submitting it
	// to IAM. The regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate
	// this parameter is a string of characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any
	// printable ASCII character ranging from the space character (\u0020) through the
	// end of the ASCII character range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin
	// and Latin-1 Supplement character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters
	// tab (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PolicyDocument *string

	// The name of the role to update with the new policy. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput

type UpdateAssumeRolePolicyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateGroupInput

type UpdateGroupInput struct {

	// Name of the IAM group to update. If you're changing the name of the group, this
	// is the original name. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	GroupName *string

	// New name for the IAM group. Only include this if changing the group's name. IAM
	// user, group, role, and policy names must be unique within the account. Names are
	// not distinguished by case. For example, you cannot create resources named both
	// "MyResource" and "myresource".
	NewGroupName *string

	// New path for the IAM group. Only include this if changing the group's path. This
	// parameter allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a
	// string of characters consisting of either a forward slash (/) by itself or a
	// string that must begin and end with forward slashes. In addition, it can contain
	// any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021) through the DEL character (\u007F),
	// including most punctuation characters, digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	NewPath *string
}

type UpdateGroupOutput

type UpdateGroupOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateLoginProfileInput

type UpdateLoginProfileInput struct {

	// The name of the user whose password you want to update. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// The new password for the specified IAM user. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// However, the format can be further
	// restricted by the account administrator by setting a password policy on the AWS
	// account. For more information, see UpdateAccountPasswordPolicy.
	Password *string

	// Allows this new password to be used only once by requiring the specified IAM
	// user to set a new password on next sign-in.
	PasswordResetRequired *bool
}

type UpdateLoginProfileOutput

type UpdateLoginProfileOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput

type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintInput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM OIDC provider resource object for
	// which you want to update the thumbprint. You can get a list of OIDC provider
	// ARNs by using the ListOpenIDConnectProviders operation. For more information
	// about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	OpenIDConnectProviderArn *string

	// A list of certificate thumbprints that are associated with the specified IAM
	// OpenID Connect provider. For more information, see CreateOpenIDConnectProvider.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ThumbprintList []string
}

type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput

type UpdateOpenIDConnectProviderThumbprintOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateRoleDescriptionInput

type UpdateRoleDescriptionInput struct {

	// The new description that you want to apply to the specified role.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Description *string

	// The name of the role that you want to modify.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string
}

type UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput

type UpdateRoleDescriptionOutput struct {

	// A structure that contains details about the modified role.
	Role *types.Role

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateRoleInput

type UpdateRoleInput struct {

	// The name of the role that you want to modify.
	//
	// This member is required.
	RoleName *string

	// The new description that you want to apply to the specified role.
	Description *string

	// The maximum session duration (in seconds) that you want to set for the specified
	// role. If you do not specify a value for this setting, the default maximum of one
	// hour is applied. This setting can have a value from 1 hour to 12 hours. Anyone
	// who assumes the role from the AWS CLI or API can use the DurationSeconds API
	// parameter or the duration-seconds CLI parameter to request a longer session. The
	// MaxSessionDuration setting determines the maximum duration that can be requested
	// using the DurationSeconds parameter. If users don't specify a value for the
	// DurationSeconds parameter, their security credentials are valid for one hour by
	// default. This applies when you use the AssumeRole* API operations or the
	// assume-role* CLI operations but does not apply when you use those operations to
	// create a console URL. For more information, see Using IAM Roles
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/id_roles_use.html) in the IAM
	// User Guide.
	MaxSessionDuration *int32
}

type UpdateRoleOutput

type UpdateRoleOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateSAMLProviderInput

type UpdateSAMLProviderInput struct {

	// An XML document generated by an identity provider (IdP) that supports SAML 2.0.
	// The document includes the issuer's name, expiration information, and keys that
	// can be used to validate the SAML authentication response (assertions) that are
	// received from the IdP. You must generate the metadata document using the
	// identity management software that is used as your organization's IdP.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SAMLMetadataDocument *string

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider to update. For more
	// information about ARNs, see Amazon Resource Names (ARNs) and AWS Service
	// Namespaces
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/aws-arns-and-namespaces.html) in
	// the AWS General Reference.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SAMLProviderArn *string
}

type UpdateSAMLProviderOutput

type UpdateSAMLProviderOutput struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SAML provider that was updated.
	SAMLProviderArn *string

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful UpdateSAMLProvider request.

type UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput

type UpdateSSHPublicKeyInput struct {

	// The unique identifier for the SSH public key. This parameter allows (through its
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters that can
	// consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	SSHPublicKeyId *string

	// The status to assign to the SSH public key. Active means that the key can be
	// used for authentication with an AWS CodeCommit repository. Inactive means that
	// the key cannot be used.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Status types.StatusType

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the SSH public key. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput

type UpdateSSHPublicKeyOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateServerCertificateInput

type UpdateServerCertificateInput struct {

	// The name of the server certificate that you want to update. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificateName *string

	// The new path for the server certificate. Include this only if you are updating
	// the server certificate's path. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	NewPath *string

	// The new name for the server certificate. Include this only if you are updating
	// the server certificate's name. The name of the certificate cannot contain any
	// spaces. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	NewServerCertificateName *string
}

type UpdateServerCertificateOutput

type UpdateServerCertificateOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput

type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialInput struct {

	// The unique identifier of the service-specific credential. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServiceSpecificCredentialId *string

	// The status to be assigned to the service-specific credential.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Status types.StatusType

	// The name of the IAM user associated with the service-specific credential. If you
	// do not specify this value, then the operation assumes the user whose credentials
	// are used to call the operation. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput

type UpdateServiceSpecificCredentialOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateSigningCertificateInput

type UpdateSigningCertificateInput struct {

	// The ID of the signing certificate you want to update. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters that can consist of any upper or lowercased letter or digit.
	//
	// This member is required.
	CertificateId *string

	// The status you want to assign to the certificate. Active means that the
	// certificate can be used for API calls to AWS Inactive means that the certificate
	// cannot be used.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Status types.StatusType

	// The name of the IAM user the signing certificate belongs to. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type UpdateSigningCertificateOutput

type UpdateSigningCertificateOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UpdateUserInput

type UpdateUserInput struct {

	// Name of the user to update. If you're changing the name of the user, this is the
	// original user name. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of upper
	// and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no spaces. You can also include any
	// of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string

	// New path for the IAM user. Include this parameter only if you're changing the
	// user's path. This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters.
	NewPath *string

	// New name for the user. Include this parameter only if you're changing the user's
	// name. IAM user, group, role, and policy names must be unique within the account.
	// Names are not distinguished by case. For example, you cannot create resources
	// named both "MyResource" and "myresource".
	NewUserName *string
}

type UpdateUserOutput

type UpdateUserOutput struct {
	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

type UploadSSHPublicKeyInput

type UploadSSHPublicKeyInput struct {

	// The SSH public key. The public key must be encoded in ssh-rsa format or PEM
	// format. The minimum bit-length of the public key is 2048 bits. For example, you
	// can generate a 2048-bit key, and the resulting PEM file is 1679 bytes long. The
	// regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter
	// is a string of characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII
	// character ranging from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII
	// character range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1
	// Supplement character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab
	// (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	SSHPublicKeyBody *string

	// The name of the IAM user to associate the SSH public key with. This parameter
	// allows (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	UserName *string
}

type UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput

type UploadSSHPublicKeyOutput struct {

	// Contains information about the SSH public key.
	SSHPublicKey *types.SSHPublicKey

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful UploadSSHPublicKey request.

type UploadServerCertificateInput

type UploadServerCertificateInput struct {

	// The contents of the public key certificate in PEM-encoded format. The regex
	// pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a
	// string of characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII
	// character ranging from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII
	// character range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1
	// Supplement character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab
	// (\u0009), line feed (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	CertificateBody *string

	// The contents of the private key in PEM-encoded format. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	PrivateKey *string

	// The name for the server certificate. Do not include the path in this value. The
	// name of the certificate cannot contain any spaces. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	//
	// This member is required.
	ServerCertificateName *string

	// The contents of the certificate chain. This is typically a concatenation of the
	// PEM-encoded public key certificates of the chain. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	CertificateChain *string

	// The path for the server certificate. For more information about paths, see IAM
	// Identifiers
	// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/IAM/latest/UserGuide/Using_Identifiers.html) in the
	// IAM User Guide. This parameter is optional. If it is not included, it defaults
	// to a slash (/). This parameter allows (through its regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of characters consisting of either a
	// forward slash (/) by itself or a string that must begin and end with forward
	// slashes. In addition, it can contain any ASCII character from the ! (\u0021)
	// through the DEL character (\u007F), including most punctuation characters,
	// digits, and upper and lowercased letters. If you are uploading a server
	// certificate specifically for use with Amazon CloudFront distributions, you must
	// specify a path using the path parameter. The path must begin with /cloudfront
	// and must include a trailing slash (for example, /cloudfront/test/).
	Path *string
}

type UploadServerCertificateOutput

type UploadServerCertificateOutput struct {

	// The meta information of the uploaded server certificate without its certificate
	// body, certificate chain, and private key.
	ServerCertificateMetadata *types.ServerCertificateMetadata

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful UploadServerCertificate request.

type UploadSigningCertificateInput

type UploadSigningCertificateInput struct {

	// The contents of the signing certificate. The regex pattern
	// (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex) used to validate this parameter is a string of
	// characters consisting of the following:
	//
	// * Any printable ASCII character ranging
	// from the space character (\u0020) through the end of the ASCII character
	// range
	//
	// * The printable characters in the Basic Latin and Latin-1 Supplement
	// character set (through \u00FF)
	//
	// * The special characters tab (\u0009), line feed
	// (\u000A), and carriage return (\u000D)
	//
	// This member is required.
	CertificateBody *string

	// The name of the user the signing certificate is for. This parameter allows
	// (through its regex pattern (http://wikipedia.org/wiki/regex)) a string of
	// characters consisting of upper and lowercase alphanumeric characters with no
	// spaces. You can also include any of the following characters: _+=,.@-
	UserName *string
}

type UploadSigningCertificateOutput

type UploadSigningCertificateOutput struct {

	// Information about the certificate.
	//
	// This member is required.
	Certificate *types.SigningCertificate

	// Metadata pertaining to the operation's result.
	ResultMetadata middleware.Metadata
}

Contains the response to a successful UploadSigningCertificate request.

Source Files

Directories

Path Synopsis
internal

Jump to

Keyboard shortcuts

? : This menu
/ : Search site
f or F : Jump to
y or Y : Canonical URL